blob: ee6f81c1d7cdb8f6af25ea027f4f66598f419b70 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200583 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100584 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200585 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-options
589 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-options
592 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100593 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100594 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100596 - 51degrees-data-file
597 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200598 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200599 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200600 - wurfl-data-file
601 - wurfl-information-list
602 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200603 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100604
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200606 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200608 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100609 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100610 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200612 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200613 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200614 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - noepoll
617 - nokqueue
618 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300620 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000621 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100622 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200623 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200624 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200625 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000626 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000627 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - tune.buffers.limit
629 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200630 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200631 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100632 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200633 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200634 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200635 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100636 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200637 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200638 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100639 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100640 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100641 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100642 - tune.lua.session-timeout
643 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200644 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100645 - tune.maxaccept
646 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200647 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200648 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200649 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.rcvbuf.client
651 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100652 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200653 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100654 - tune.sndbuf.client
655 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100656 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100657 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200658 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100659 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200660 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200661 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100662 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200663 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100664 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200665 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
666 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
667 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100668 - tune.zlib.memlevel
669 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671 * Debugging
672 - debug
673 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674
675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677------------------------------------
678
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679ca-base <dir>
680 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200681 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
682 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200684chroot <jail dir>
685 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
686 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
687 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
688 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
689 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100690 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100692cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
693 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
694 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
695 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
696 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
697 set. These sets have the format
698
699 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
700
701 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100702 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100703 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
704 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100705 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
706 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100707 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100708 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100709 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100710 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
712 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
713 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
714 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100715
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100716 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
717 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
718 on the machine's word size.
719
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100720 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100721 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
722 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
723 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
724 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
725 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
726 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100727
728 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
730
731 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
732 # first 4 CPUs
733
734 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
735 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
736 # word size.
737
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100738 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100739 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
743
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100744 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
745 # and so on.
746 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
749
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100750 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100751 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
752 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
753 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
754
755 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
756 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
757 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
758
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
760 # and a thread range.
761 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
762 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
764
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200765crt-base <dir>
766 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
767 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
768 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770daemon
771 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
772 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100773 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
774 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200775
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200776deviceatlas-json-file <path>
777 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100778 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200779
780deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100781 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200782 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
783
784deviceatlas-separator <char>
785 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
786 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
787
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100788deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200789 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
790 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
791 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100792
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900793external-check
794 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
795 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
796 See "option external-check".
797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200798gid <number>
799 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
800 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
801 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100802 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
803 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100805
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100806hard-stop-after <time>
807 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
808
809 Arguments :
810 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
811 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
812 SIGUSR1 signal.
813
814 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
815 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
816 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
817
818 Example:
819 global
820 hard-stop-after 30s
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822group <group name>
823 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
824 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100825
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200826log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
827 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200903 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
904 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
905 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
906 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
907 set with <sample_size> parameter.
908
909 <sample_size>
910 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
911 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
912 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
913 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
914 (see also <ranges> parameter).
915
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200917
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100918 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
919 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
920 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
921
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100922 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
923 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
924 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
925 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926
927 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200928 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
929 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
930 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
931 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
932 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
933 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200934
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200935 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100937log-send-hostname [<string>]
938 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
939 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
940 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
941 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
942 the logs.
943
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000944log-tag <string>
945 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
946 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
947 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100948 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000949
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100950lua-load <file>
951 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
952 used multiple times.
953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
956 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
957 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100958 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200959 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
960 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100961 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
962 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
963 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
964 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
965 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200966
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100967 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969nbproc <number>
970 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
971 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
972 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100973 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
974 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100975 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
976 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200978nbthread <number>
979 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100980 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
981 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
982 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
983 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
984 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100985 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
986 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
987 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
988 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
989 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
990 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
991 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200992
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100994 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
996 starting the process. See also "daemon".
997
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100998presetenv <name> <value>
999 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1000 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1001 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1002 and "unsetenv".
1003
1004resetenv [<name> ...]
1005 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1006 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1007 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1008 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1009 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1010 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1011 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1012 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1013
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001014stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001015 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1016 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1017 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1018 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1019 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1020 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001021 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001022 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1023 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1024 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1025 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001026
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001027server-state-base <directory>
1028 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001029 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1030 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001031
1032server-state-file <file>
1033 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1034 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1035 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1036 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1037 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1038 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1039 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1040 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001041 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1042 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001043
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001044setenv <name> <value>
1045 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1046 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1047 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1048 and "unsetenv".
1049
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001050set-dumpable
1051 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1052 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1053 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1054 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1055 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1056 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1057 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1058 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1059 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1060 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1061 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1062 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1063 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1064 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1065 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1066 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1067 expected when dying.
1068
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001069ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1071 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001072 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001073 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001074 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1075 information and recommendations see e.g.
1076 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1077 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1078 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1079 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001080
1081ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1082 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1083 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1084 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1085 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1086 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001087 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1088 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1089 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001090 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001091
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001092ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1093 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1094 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1095 keyword to see available options.
1096
1097 Example:
1098 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001099 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001100
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001101ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1103 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001104 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001105 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001106 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1107 information and recommendations see e.g.
1108 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1109 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1110 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1111 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1112 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001113
1114ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1116 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1117 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1118 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1119 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001120 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1121 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1122 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1123 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001124
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001125ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1127 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1128 keyword to see available options.
1129
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001130ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1132 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1133 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001134 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001135 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001136 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1137 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1138 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1139 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001140 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1141 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1142 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1143
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001144ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1145 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1146 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1147 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1148
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001149stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1150 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1151 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1152 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001153 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001154 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001155
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001156 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1157 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1158 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001159
1160stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1161 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1162 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001163 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001164
1165stats maxconn <connections>
1166 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1167 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1168
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001169uid <number>
1170 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1171 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1172 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1173 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1174
1175ulimit-n <number>
1176 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1177 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1178 option.
1179
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001180unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1181 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1182
1183 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1184 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1185 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1186 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1187 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1188 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1189 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1190 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1191 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1192 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1193
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001194unsetenv [<name> ...]
1195 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1196 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1197 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1198 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1199 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1200 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1201 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203user <user name>
1204 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1205 See also "uid" and "group".
1206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001207node <name>
1208 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1209
1210 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1211 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1212 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1213 traffic.
1214
1215description <text>
1216 Add a text that describes the instance.
1217
1218 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1219 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1220 "<" and ">" characters.
1221
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100122251degrees-data-file <file path>
1223 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001224 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001225
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001226 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001227 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1228
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000122951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001230 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1231 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1232 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1233
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001234 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001235 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1236
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200123751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001238 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1239 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1240
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001241 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1242 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1243
124451degrees-cache-size <number>
1245 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1246 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1247 By default, this cache is disabled.
1248
1249 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001250 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1251
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001252wurfl-data-file <file path>
1253 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1254 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1255
1256 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1257 with USE_WURFL=1.
1258
1259wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1260 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1261 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1262 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1263
1264 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1265
1266 Valid WURFL properties are:
1267 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1268
1269 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1270 device.
1271
1272 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1273 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1274
1275 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1276 particular web request.
1277
1278 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1279 used Libwurfl API version.
1280
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001281 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1282 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1283
1284 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1285 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1286
1287 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1288
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001289 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1290 with USE_WURFL=1.
1291
1292wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1293 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1294 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1295
1296 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1297 with USE_WURFL=1.
1298
1299wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1300 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1301 thus before the chroot.
1302
1303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1304 with USE_WURFL=1.
1305
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001306wurfl-cache-size <size>
1307 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1308 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001309 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001310 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001311
1312 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1313 with USE_WURFL=1.
1314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013153.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001316-----------------------
1317
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001318busy-polling
1319 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1320 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1321 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1322 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1323 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1324 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1325 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1326 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1327 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1328 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1329 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1330 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1331 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1332 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1333 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1334 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1335 "poll" pollers.
1336
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001337max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1338 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1339 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1340 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1341 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1342 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1343 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1344 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1345 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001347maxconn <number>
1348 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1349 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1350 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001351 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1352 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1353 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1354 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001355 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1356 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1357 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1358 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1359 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1360 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001361
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001362maxconnrate <number>
1363 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1364 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1365 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1366 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1367 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1368 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1369 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1370 fairness.
1371
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001372maxcomprate <number>
1373 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001374 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001375 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1376 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1377 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001378 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001379 default value.
1380
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001381maxcompcpuusage <number>
1382 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1383 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1384 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1385 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1386 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1387 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1388 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1389 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1390
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001391maxpipes <number>
1392 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1393 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1394 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1395 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1396 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1397 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1398
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001399maxsessrate <number>
1400 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1401 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1402 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1403 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1404 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1405 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1406 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1407 fairness.
1408
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001409maxsslconn <number>
1410 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1411 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1412 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1413 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1414 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1415 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1416 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001417 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1418 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1419 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1420 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1421 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1422 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1423 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001424
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001425maxsslrate <number>
1426 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1427 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1428 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1429 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1430 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1431 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1432 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1433 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1434 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1435 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1436
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001437maxzlibmem <number>
1438 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1439 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1440 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001441 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1442 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1443 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1444
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001445noepoll
1446 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1447 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001448 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001449
1450nokqueue
1451 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1452 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1453 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1454
1455nopoll
1456 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1457 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001458 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001459 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001460
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001461nosplice
1462 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001463 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001464 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001465 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001466 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1467 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1468 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1469 "option splice-response".
1470
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001471nogetaddrinfo
1472 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1473 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1474
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001475noreuseport
1476 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1477 command line argument "-dR".
1478
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001479profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1480 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1481 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1482 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1483 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1484 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1485 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1486 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1487 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1488 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1489
1490 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1491 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1492 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1493 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1494 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001495 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1496 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1497 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1498 CLI.
1499
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001500spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001501 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1502 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1503 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1504 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1505 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1506 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001507
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001508ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001509 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001510 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001511 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1512 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1513 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1514 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1515 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1517 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001518 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1519 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1520 openssl configuration file uses:
1521 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1522
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001523ssl-mode-async
1524 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001525 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001526 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1527 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1528 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1529 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1530 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001531
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001532tune.buffers.limit <number>
1533 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1534 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1535 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1536 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1537 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001538 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001539 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1540 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1541 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1542 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1543 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1544 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1545 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1546 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1547 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1548
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001549tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1550 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1551 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1552 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1553 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1554
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001555tune.bufsize <number>
1556 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1557 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1558 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1559 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1560 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1561 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1562 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001563 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1564 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1565 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001566 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001567 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1568 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1569 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001570
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001571tune.chksize <number>
1572 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1573 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1574 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1575 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1576 checks whenever possible.
1577
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001578tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1579 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1580 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1581 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1582 this value. The default value is 1.
1583
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001584tune.fail-alloc
1585 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1586 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1587 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1588 gracefully.
1589
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001590tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1591 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1592 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1593 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1594 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1595 change it.
1596
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001597tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1598 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001599 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1600 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001601 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1602 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1603 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1604 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1605 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1606
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001607tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1608 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1609 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1610 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1611 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1612 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1613 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1614 recommended not to change this value.
1615
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001616tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1617 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1618 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1619 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1620 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1621 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1622 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1623 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1624
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001625tune.http.cookielen <number>
1626 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1627 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1628 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1629 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1630 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1631 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1632 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1633 to change this value.
1634
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001635tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001636 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1637 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001638 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001639 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001640 configuration directives too.
1641 The default value is 1024.
1642
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001643tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1644 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1645 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1646 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1647 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1648 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1649 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001650 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1651 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1652 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001653
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001654tune.idletimer <timeout>
1655 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1656 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1657 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1658 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1659 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1660 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001661 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001662 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1663 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1664
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001665tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1666 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1667 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1668 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1669 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1670 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1671 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1672 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1673 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1674 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1675
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001676tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1677 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001678 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001679 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1680 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001681 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001682 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1683 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1684
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001685tune.lua.maxmem
1686 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1687 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1688 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1689 memory.
1690
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001691tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1692 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001693 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1694 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001695 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001696
1697tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1698 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1699 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1700 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1701 check servers.
1702
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001703tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1704 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1705 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1706 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001707 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001708
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001709tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001710 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1711 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1712 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1713 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1714 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1715 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1716 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1717 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1718 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1719 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001720
1721tune.maxpollevents <number>
1722 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1723 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1724 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1725 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1726 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1727
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001728tune.maxrewrite <number>
1729 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1730 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1731 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1732 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1733 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1734 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1735 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1736 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1737 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1738 bufsize.
1739
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001740tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1741 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1742 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1743 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1744 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1745 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1746 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1747 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1748 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1749 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1750 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1751 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1752 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1753 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1754 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1755 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1756 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1757 setting this parameter to 0.
1758
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001759tune.pipesize <number>
1760 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1761 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1762 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1763 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1764 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1765 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1766
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001767tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1768 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1769 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1770 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1771 default is 20.
1772
1773tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1774 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1775 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1776 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1777 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1778 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1779 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1780 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1781
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001782tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1783tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1784 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1785 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1786 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1787 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001788 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001789 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1790 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1791
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001792tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001794 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1795 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1796 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1797 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1798
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001799tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1800 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1801 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1802 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1803
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001804tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1805tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1806 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1807 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1808 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1809 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001810 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001811 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1812 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1813 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1814 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1815 notifying haproxy again.
1816
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001817tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001818 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1819 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1820 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001821 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001822 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001823 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001824 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1825 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1826 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001827 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1828 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001829
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001830tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001831 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001832 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1833 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1834 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1835 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1836 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1837
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001838tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1839 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001840 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001841 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1842 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1843 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1844 being used for too long.
1845
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001846tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1847 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1848 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1849 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1850 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1851 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1852 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1853 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1854 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1855 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1856 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001858 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001859
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001860tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1861 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1862 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1863 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1864 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1865 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1866 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1867 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1869 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001870
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001871tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1872 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1873 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1874 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1875 1000 entries.
1876
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001877tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1878 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1879 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1880 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1881
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001882tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001883tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001884tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1885tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1886tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001887 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1888 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1889 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1890 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1891 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1892 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1893 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1894 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001895
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001896 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1897 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1898 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1899 all available space is consumed.
1900 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1901 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1902 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001903
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001904tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1905 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001906 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001907 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001908 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001909 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1910
1911tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1912 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1913 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001914 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1915 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019173.3. Debugging
1918--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001919
1920debug
1921 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1922 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1923 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1924 system startup.
1925
1926quiet
1927 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1928 line argument "-q".
1929
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019313.4. Userlists
1932--------------
1933It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1934http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1935it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1936
1937userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001938 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001939 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1940
1941group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001942 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001943 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1944 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1945
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001946user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1947 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001948 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1949 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001950 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1951 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1952 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1953 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001954
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001955 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1956 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1957 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1958 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1959 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1960 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1961 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1962 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1963 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001964
1965 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001966 userlist L1
1967 group G1 users tiger,scott
1968 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001969
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001970 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1971 user scott insecure-password elgato
1972 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001973
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001974 userlist L2
1975 group G1
1976 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001978 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1979 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1980 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
1982 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001983
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001984
19853.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001986----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001987It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1988several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1989instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1990values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1991automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1992In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1993using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1994tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1995reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1996Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1997that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1998each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001999
2000peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002001 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002002 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2003
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002004bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2005 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2006 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2007
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002008disabled
2009 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2010 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2011 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002013default-bind [param*]
2014 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2015
2016default-server [param*]
2017 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2018
2019 Arguments:
2020 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2021 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2022 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2023 details.
2024
2025
2026 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2027
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002028enable
2029 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2030
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002031peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002032 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2033 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2034 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2035 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2036 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2037 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2038
2039 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2040 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2041
2042 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2043 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2044 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2045 across all peers.
2046
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002047 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2048 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002049
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002050 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2051 "server" keyword explanation below).
2052
2053server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2054 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2055 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2056 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2057 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2058 of this "peers" section).
2059 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2060
2061
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002062 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002063 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002064 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002065 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2066 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2067 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002068
2069 backend mybackend
2070 mode tcp
2071 balance roundrobin
2072 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2073 stick on src
2074
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002075 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2076 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002077
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002078 Example:
2079 peers mypeers
2080 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2081 default-server ssl verify none
2082 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2083 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002084
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020853.6. Mailers
2086------------
2087It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2088If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2089in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2090
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002091mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002092 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2093 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2094
2095mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2096 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2097
2098 Example:
2099 mailers mymailers
2100 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2101 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2102
2103 backend mybackend
2104 mode tcp
2105 balance roundrobin
2106
2107 email-alert mailers mymailers
2108 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2109 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2110
2111 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2112 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2113
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002114timeout mail <time>
2115 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2116 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2117 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2118 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2119
2120 Example:
2121 mailers mymailers
2122 timeout mail 20s
2123 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021254. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002126----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002128Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002129 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002130 - frontend <name>
2131 - backend <name>
2132 - listen <name>
2133
2134A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2135its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2136section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002137section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138
2139A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2140connections.
2141
2142A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2143to forward incoming connections.
2144
2145A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2146parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2149'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2150case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2151
2152Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2153logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2154proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2155However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2156name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2157
2158Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2159and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002160bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002161protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2162modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2163arbitrary criteria.
2164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002165In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2166a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002167the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002168
2169 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2170 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2171 between responses and new requests.
2172
2173 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2174 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2175 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002176 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2177 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2178 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2179 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002181 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2182 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2183 client-facing connection remains open.
2184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002185 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2186 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002187
2188The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2189frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2190following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002191weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002192
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002193 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002194
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002195 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2196 ----+-----+-----+----
2197 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2198 ----+-----+-----+----
2199 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2200 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2201 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2202 ----+-----+-----+----
2203 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002204
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022074.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2208--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002210The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2211limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2212they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2213limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002214marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002215option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002216and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2217with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2218specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002220
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002221 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2222------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2223acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002224appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002225backlog X X X -
2226balance X - X X
2227bind - X X -
2228bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002229block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002230capture cookie - X X -
2231capture request header - X X -
2232capture response header - X X -
2233clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002234compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002235contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2236cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002237declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002238default-server X - X X
2239default_backend X X X -
2240description - X X X
2241disabled X X X X
2242dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002243email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002244email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002245email-alert mailers X X X X
2246email-alert myhostname X X X X
2247email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002248enabled X X X X
2249errorfile X X X X
2250errorloc X X X X
2251errorloc302 X X X X
2252-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2253errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002254force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002255filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002256fullconn X - X X
2257grace X X X X
2258hash-type X - X X
2259http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002260http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002261http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002262http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002263http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002264http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002265http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002267ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002268load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002269log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002270log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002271log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002272log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002273max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002274maxconn X X X -
2275mode X X X X
2276monitor fail - X X -
2277monitor-net X X X -
2278monitor-uri X X X -
2279option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2280option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2281option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2282option allbackups (*) X - X X
2283option checkcache (*) X - X X
2284option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2285option contstats (*) X X X -
2286option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2287option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002288option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002289-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2290option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002291option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002292option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002293option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002294option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002295option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002296option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002297option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002298option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002299option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002300option httpchk X - X X
2301option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002302option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002303option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002304option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002305option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002306option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002307option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2308option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2309option logasap (*) X X X -
2310option mysql-check X - X X
2311option nolinger (*) X X X X
2312option originalto X X X X
2313option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002314option pgsql-check X - X X
2315option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002316option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002317option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002318option smtpchk X - X X
2319option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2320option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2321option splice-request (*) X X X X
2322option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002323option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002324option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2325option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2326-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002327option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002328option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2329option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2330option tcpka X X X X
2331option tcplog X X X X
2332option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002333external-check command X - X X
2334external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002335persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2336rate-limit sessions X X X -
2337redirect - X X X
2338redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2339redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2340reqadd - X X X
2341reqallow - X X X
2342reqdel - X X X
2343reqdeny - X X X
2344reqiallow - X X X
2345reqidel - X X X
2346reqideny - X X X
2347reqipass - X X X
2348reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002349reqitarpit - X X X
2350reqpass - X X X
2351reqrep - X X X
2352-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002353reqtarpit - X X X
2354retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002355retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002356rspadd - X X X
2357rspdel - X X X
2358rspdeny - X X X
2359rspidel - X X X
2360rspideny - X X X
2361rspirep - X X X
2362rsprep - X X X
2363server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002364server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002365server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002366source X - X X
2367srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002368stats admin - X X X
2369stats auth X X X X
2370stats enable X X X X
2371stats hide-version X X X X
2372stats http-request - X X X
2373stats realm X X X X
2374stats refresh X X X X
2375stats scope X X X X
2376stats show-desc X X X X
2377stats show-legends X X X X
2378stats show-node X X X X
2379stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002380-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2381stick match - - X X
2382stick on - - X X
2383stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002384stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002385stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002386tcp-check connect - - X X
2387tcp-check expect - - X X
2388tcp-check send - - X X
2389tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002390tcp-request connection - X X -
2391tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002392tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002393tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002394tcp-response content - - X X
2395tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002396timeout check X - X X
2397timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002398timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002399timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2400timeout connect X - X X
2401timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2402timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2403timeout http-request X X X X
2404timeout queue X - X X
2405timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002406timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002407timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2408timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002409timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002411unique-id-format X X X -
2412unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002413use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002414use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2416 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024194.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2420---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002421
2422This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2423
2424
2425acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2426 Declare or complete an access list.
2427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2428 no | yes | yes | yes
2429 Example:
2430 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2431 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2432 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002434 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002435
2436
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002437appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2438 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2441 no | no | yes | yes
2442 Arguments :
2443 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2444 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2445
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002446 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447 checked in each cookie value.
2448
2449 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2450 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2451 milliseconds.
2452
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002453 request-learn
2454 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2455 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2456 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2457 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2458 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2459 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2460
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002461 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2462 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2463 data following this prefix.
2464
2465 Example :
2466 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2467
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002468 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2469 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002470
2471 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2472 2 modes are currently supported :
2473 - path-parameters :
2474 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2475 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2476 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2477 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2478 - query-string :
2479 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2480 query string.
2481
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002482 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2483 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2484 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002486 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2487 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002488
2489
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002490backlog <conns>
2491 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2493 yes | yes | yes | no
2494 Arguments :
2495 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2496 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002497 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002498
2499 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2500 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2501 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2502 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2503 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2504 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2505 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2506 backlog parameter.
2507
2508 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2509 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2510 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2511
2512 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2513
2514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002516balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002517 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2519 yes | no | yes | yes
2520 Arguments :
2521 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2522 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2523 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2524 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2525
2526 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2527 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2528 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2529 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002530 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002531 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002532 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2533 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2534 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2535 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2536 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2537 it, so that you don't worry.
2538
2539 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2540 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2541 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2542 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2543 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2544 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2545 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2546 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002548 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2549 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2550 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2551 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2552 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2553 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2554 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2555 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2556
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002557 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002558 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002559 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2560 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002561 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002562 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2563 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2564 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2565 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2566 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002567 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2568 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2569 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2570 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2571 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2572 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002574 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2575 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2576 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2577 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2578 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2579 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2580 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2581 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002582 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002583 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002584 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2585 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2586 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002588 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2589 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2590 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2591 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2592 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2593 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2594 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2595 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2596 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2597 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2598 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2599 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002600
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002601 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002602 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2603 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2604 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2605 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2606 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2607 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2608 URIs start with a leading "/".
2609
2610 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2611 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2612 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2613 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2614
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002616 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2617
2618 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002619 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2620 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002621 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2622 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2623 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2624 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002625 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002626 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2627 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002628
2629 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2630 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2631 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2632 server will receive the request.
2633
2634 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2635 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2636 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2637 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2638 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002639 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2640 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2641 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002643 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2644 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2645 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2646 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2647 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002649 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002650 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2651 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2652 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2653
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002654 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2655 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2656 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2657
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002658 random
2659 random(<draws>)
2660 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002661 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2662 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2663 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2664 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002665 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2666 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2667 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2668 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2669 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2670 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2671 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2672 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2673 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2674 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2675 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2676 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2677 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2678 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2679 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2680 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2681 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2682 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2683 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2684 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002685
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002686 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002687 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002688 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2689 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2690 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2691 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2692 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2693 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002694 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002695 used instead.
2696
2697 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2698 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2699 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2700 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2701
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002702 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2703 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2704 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2705
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002706 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002708 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002709 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2710 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002711
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002712 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2713 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2714 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002716 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2717 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2718 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2719 NTLM relies on.
2720
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 Examples :
2722 balance roundrobin
2723 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002724 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002725 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2726 balance hdr(host)
2727 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002728
2729 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2730 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002732 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002733 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2734 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2735 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2736 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2737
2738 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2739 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2740 defaults to 16 kB.
2741
2742 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2743 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2744
2745 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2746 Round Robin.
2747
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002748 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002749 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2750 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2751 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2752
2753 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2754
2755 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002756 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002757 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2758 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2759 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002761 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
2763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002764bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2765bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2768 no | yes | yes | no
2769 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002770 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2771 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2772 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2773 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002774 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002775 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2776 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2777 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2778 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2779 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2780 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2781 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002782 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2783 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2784 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2785 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2786 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2787 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2788 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002789 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2790 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2791 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002792 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2793 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2794 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2795 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002796 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2797 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2798 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002799
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002800 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2801 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002802 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2803 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2804 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002805 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2806 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2807 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2808 the range.
2809
2810 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2811 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2812 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2813 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2814 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2815 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2816 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002817 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002818 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002820 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002821 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002822 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2823 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2824 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2825 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2826 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2827 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002829 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2830 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2831 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2832 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2835 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2836 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2837 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2838 in a frontend.
2839
2840 Example :
2841 listen http_proxy
2842 bind :80,:443
2843 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002844 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002846 listen http_https_proxy
2847 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002848 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002849
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002850 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2851 bind ipv6@:80
2852 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2853 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2854
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002855 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002856 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002857
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002858 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2859 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2860 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2861 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2862 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2863
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002864 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002865 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
2867
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002868bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002869 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 yes | yes | yes | yes
2872 Arguments :
2873 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2874 may be used to override a default value.
2875
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002876 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002877 option may be combined with other numbers.
2878
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002879 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002880 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2881 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2882 missing from all processes.
2883
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002884 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002885 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002886 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2887 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2888 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2889 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2890 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002891 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002892
2893 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2894 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2895 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2896 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2897 and 'even' instances.
2898
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002899 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2900 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2901 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2902 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002903
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002904 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2905 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2906
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002907 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2908 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2909 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2910
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002911 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2912 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2913
2914 Example :
2915 listen app_ip1
2916 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002917 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002918
2919 listen app_ip2
2920 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002921 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002922
2923 listen management
2924 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002925 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002926
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002927 listen management
2928 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2929 bind-process 1-4
2930
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002931 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002932
2933
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002934block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2937 no | yes | yes | yes
2938
2939 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2940 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002941 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002942 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002943 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002944 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2945 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2946 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002948 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2949 "http-request deny" instead.
2950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951 Example:
2952 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2953 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2954 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002955 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2956 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2957 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002959 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2960 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2961 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
2963capture cookie <name> len <length>
2964 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2966 no | yes | yes | no
2967 Arguments :
2968 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2969 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2970 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2971 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002972 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002973
2974 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2975 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2976 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2977 right if it exceeds <length>.
2978
2979 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2980 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2981 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2982 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2983
2984 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2985 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2986 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2987
2988 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2989 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2990 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002991 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2992 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2993 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002994
2995 Example:
2996 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2997
2998 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002999 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
3001
3002capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003003 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3005 no | yes | yes | no
3006 Arguments :
3007 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003008 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3010 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3011 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3012
3013 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3014 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3015 it exceeds <length>.
3016
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003017 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003018 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3019 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003020 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3021 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3022 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3023 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003024 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003025 environments to find where the request came from.
3026
3027 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3028 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3029 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3030 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003031
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003032 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3033 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3034 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3035 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3036 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037
3038 Example:
3039 capture request header Host len 15
3040 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003041 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003043 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003044 about logging.
3045
3046
3047capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003048 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 no | yes | yes | no
3051 Arguments :
3052 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003053 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003054 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3055 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3056 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3057
3058 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3059 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3060 it exceeds <length>.
3061
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003062 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3064 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3065 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003066 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3067 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3068 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3069 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003071 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3072 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3073 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3074 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3075 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003076
3077 Example:
3078 capture response header Content-length len 9
3079 capture response header Location len 15
3080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003081 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082 about logging.
3083
3084
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003085clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 yes | yes | yes | no
3089 Arguments :
3090 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3091 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3092 as explained at the top of this document.
3093
3094 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3095 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3096 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3097 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3098 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3099 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3100 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3101 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003102 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003104 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105
3106 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3107 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3108 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3109 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3110 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3111 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3112
3113 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3114 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3115
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003116 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3117 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003119compression algo <algorithm> ...
3120compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003121compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003122 Enable HTTP compression.
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | yes | yes | yes
3125 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003126 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3127 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3128 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3129
3130 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003131 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3132 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3133 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003134
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003135 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003136 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003137
3138 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3139 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3140 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3141 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3142 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003143 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003144
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003145 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3146 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3147 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3148 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3149 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3150 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3151 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003152 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003153
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003154 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003155 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003156 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3157 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3158 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3159 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3160 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003161
3162 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3163 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3164 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3165 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3166 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003167 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3168 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3169 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3170 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3171 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003172 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3173 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003174
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003175 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003176 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3177 "Accept-Encoding" header
3178 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003179 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003180 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3181 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3182 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3183 "multipart"
3184 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3185 header
3186 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3187 and later
3188 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3189 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003190 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003191
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003192 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003193
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003194 Examples :
3195 compression algo gzip
3196 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003197
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003198
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003199contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3202 yes | no | yes | yes
3203 Arguments :
3204 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3206 as explained at the top of this document.
3207
3208 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003209 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003210 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003211 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3213 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3214 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3215
3216 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3217 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3218 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3219 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3220 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3221 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3222
3223 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3224 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3225 instead.
3226
3227 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3228 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3229
3230
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003231cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003232 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3233 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003234 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3237 yes | no | yes | yes
3238 Arguments :
3239 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3240 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3241 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3242 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3243 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3244 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003245 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003246 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3247 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3248
3249 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3250 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3251 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3252 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3253 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3254 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003255 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3256 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003257 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003258 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3259 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260
3261 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003262 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003263
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003264 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003265 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3266 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003267 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003268 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3269 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3270 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3271 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3272 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3273 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3274 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
3276 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3277 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3278 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3279 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3280 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3281 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3282 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3283 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3284 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003285 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003286 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3287 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3288 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003289
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003290 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3291 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3292 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003293 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3294 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3295 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3296 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003297 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3298 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3299 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300
3301 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3302 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3303 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3304 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3305 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3306 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3307 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3308 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3309 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3310
3311 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3312 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3313 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3314 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3315 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3316 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3317 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3318 persistence cookie in the cache.
3319 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3320
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003321 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3322 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3323 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3324 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3325 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003326 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003327 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3328 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3329 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3330 they logout.
3331
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003332 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3333 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3334 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3335 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3336
3337 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3338 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3339 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3340 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3341 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3342 this attribute.
3343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003344 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003345 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003346 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3347 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3348 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3349 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3350 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3351 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003352
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003353 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3354 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3355 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3356 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3357 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3358 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3359 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3360 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003361 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003362 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3363 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3364 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3365 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3366 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3367 the site.
3368
3369 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3370 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3371 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3372 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3373 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3374 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3375 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3376 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3377 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3378 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3379 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3380 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3381 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003382 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003383 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3384 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3385
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003386 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3387 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3388 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3389 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3390 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3391 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003393 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3394 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3395 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3396 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398 Examples :
3399 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3400 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3401 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003402 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003403
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003404 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003406
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003407declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3408 Declares a capture slot.
3409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3410 no | yes | yes | no
3411 Arguments:
3412 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3413
3414 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3415 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3416 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3417 for use in the response.
3418
3419 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003420 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003421 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3422
3423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003424default-server [param*]
3425 Change default options for a server in a backend
3426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3427 yes | no | yes | yes
3428 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003429 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3430 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3431 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3432 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003433
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003434 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003435 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3436
3437 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003438
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003439
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440default_backend <backend>
3441 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3443 yes | yes | yes | no
3444 Arguments :
3445 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3446
3447 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3448 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3449 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3450 will catch all undetermined requests.
3451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452 Example :
3453
3454 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3455 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3456 default_backend dynamic
3457
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003458 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003461description <string>
3462 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3464 no | yes | yes | yes
3465 Arguments : string
3466
3467 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3468 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3469 it describes.
3470 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3471
3472
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473disabled
3474 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | yes | yes | yes
3477 Arguments : none
3478
3479 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3480 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3481 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3482 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3483 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3484 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3485 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3486
3487 See also : "enabled"
3488
3489
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003490dispatch <address>:<port>
3491 Set a default server address
3492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003494 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003495
3496 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3497 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3498 during start-up.
3499
3500 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3501 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3502 possible with normal servers.
3503
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003504 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003505 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3506 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3507 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3508 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3509
3510 See also : "server"
3511
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003512
3513dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3514 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3516 yes | no | yes | yes
3517 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3518
3519 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003520 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003521 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3522 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003523 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003524 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003526enabled
3527 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3529 yes | yes | yes | yes
3530 Arguments : none
3531
3532 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3533 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3534
3535 See also : "disabled"
3536
3537
3538errorfile <code> <file>
3539 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 yes | yes | yes | yes
3542 Arguments :
3543 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003544 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3545 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003546
3547 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003548 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003549 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003550 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3551 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003552
3553 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3554 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3555 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3556
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003557 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3560 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3561 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3562 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3563
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003564 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3565 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003566 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003567 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3568 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3569 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3570
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003571 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3572 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3573 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003574 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003575 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3576
3577 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3578
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003579 Example :
3580 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003581 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003582 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3583 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585
3586errorloc <code> <url>
3587errorloc302 <code> <url>
3588 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 yes | yes | yes | yes
3591 Arguments :
3592 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003593 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3594 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003595
3596 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3597 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3598 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3599 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003600 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003601
3602 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3603 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3604 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3605
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003606 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003608 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3609 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3610 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3611 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003612 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003613 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3614 request.
3615
3616 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3617
3618
3619errorloc303 <code> <url>
3620 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3622 yes | yes | yes | yes
3623 Arguments :
3624 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003625 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3626 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003627
3628 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3629 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3630 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3631 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003632 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003633
3634 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3635 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3636 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3637
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003638 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3639
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003640 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3641 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3642 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3643 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003644 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003645
3646 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3647
3648
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003649email-alert from <emailaddr>
3650 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003651 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654
3655 Arguments :
3656
3657 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3658
3659 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3660 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3661
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003662 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003663 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3664 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003665
3666
3667email-alert level <level>
3668 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3669 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3670 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3671 yes | yes | yes | yes
3672
3673 Arguments :
3674
3675 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3676 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3677 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3678
3679 By default level is alert
3680
3681 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3682 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3683 for the proxy.
3684
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003685 Alerts are sent when :
3686
3687 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3688 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3689 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3690 is notice or lower
3691 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3692 and a health check status update occurs
3693
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003694 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3695 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003696 section 3.6 about mailers.
3697
3698
3699email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3700 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3702 yes | yes | yes | yes
3703
3704 Arguments :
3705
3706 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3707
3708 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3709 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3710
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003711 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3712 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003713
3714
3715email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3716 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3717 mailers.
3718 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 yes | yes | yes | yes
3720
3721 Arguments :
3722
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003723 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003724
3725 By default the systems hostname is used.
3726
3727 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3728 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3729 for the proxy.
3730
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003731 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3732 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003733
3734
3735email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003736 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003737 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3738 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | yes
3740
3741 Arguments :
3742
3743 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3744
3745 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3746 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3747
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003748 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003749 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3750
3751
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003752force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3753 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3754 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003755 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003756
3757 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3758 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3759 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3760 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3761 marked down for maintenance operations.
3762
3763 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3764 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3765 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3766 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3767 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3768 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3769 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3770 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3771 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3772
3773 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3774 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3775 is used.
3776
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003777 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003778 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003779
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003780
3781filter <name> [param*]
3782 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3784 no | yes | yes | yes
3785 Arguments :
3786 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3787 referenced in section 9.
3788
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003789 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003790 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003791 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3792 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003793
3794 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3795 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3796
3797 Example:
3798 listen
3799 bind *:80
3800
3801 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3802 filter compression
3803 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3804
3805 compression algo gzip
3806 compression offload
3807
3808 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3809
3810 See also : section 9.
3811
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003813fullconn <conns>
3814 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3816 yes | no | yes | yes
3817 Arguments :
3818 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3819 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3820
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003821 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003822 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003823 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003824 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3825 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3826 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3827 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3828 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003829 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003830
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003831 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3832 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003833 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3834 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3835 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003837 Example :
3838 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3839 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3840 # connections.
3841 backend dynamic
3842 fullconn 10000
3843 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3844 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3845
3846 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3847
3848
3849grace <time>
3850 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003852 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003853 Arguments :
3854 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3855 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3856 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3857
3858 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3859 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003860 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003861 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3862
3863 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3864 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3865 simplify it.
3866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003868hash-balance-factor <factor>
3869 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3871 yes | no | no | yes
3872 Arguments :
3873 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3874 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003875 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003876
3877 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3878 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3879 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3880 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3881 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3882 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3883 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3884
3885 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3886 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3887 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3888 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3889 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3890
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003891 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3892 consistent hashing mechanism.
3893
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003894 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3895
3896
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003897hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003898 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3900 yes | no | yes | yes
3901 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003902 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3903 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003904
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003905 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3906 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3907 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3908 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3909 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3910 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3911 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3912 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3913 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3914 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003915
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003916 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3917 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3918 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3919 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3920 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3921 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3922 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3923 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3924 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3925 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3926 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3927 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3928 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003929 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3930 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003931
3932 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3933
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003934 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003935 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3936 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3937 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003938 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3939 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3940 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003941
3942 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3943 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003944 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3945 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3946 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3947 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3948
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003949 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3950 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3951 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3952 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3953 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3954 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3955 parameter.
3956
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003957 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3958 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3959 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3960 used on strings.
3961
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003962 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3963
3964 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3965 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3966 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3967 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3968 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3969 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3970 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3971 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3972 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3973 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3974 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3975 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003976
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003977 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3978 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3979 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003980
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003981 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003982
3983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003984http-check disable-on-404
3985 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003987 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003988 Arguments : none
3989
3990 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3991 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3992 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3993 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3994 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3995 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3996 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3997 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003998 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3999 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4000 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4001
4002 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4003
4004
4005http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004006 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004008 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004009 Arguments :
4010 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4011 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004012 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004013 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4014 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4015 details on the supported keywords.
4016
4017 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4018 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4019 with the usual backslash ('\').
4020
4021 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4022 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4023 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4024 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4025 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4026
4027 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004028 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004029 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4030 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4031 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4032
4033 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004034 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004035 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4036 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4037 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4038 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4039
4040 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004041 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004042 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4043 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4044 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4045 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4046 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004047 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004048 trace).
4049
4050 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004051 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004052 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4053 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4054 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4055 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4056 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004057 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004058
4059 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4060 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4061 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4062 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4063 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4064 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4065 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4066 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4067
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004068 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4069 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4070 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4071
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004072 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4073 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4074
4075 Examples :
4076 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004077 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004078
4079 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004080 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004081
4082 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004083 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004084
4085 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004086 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004088 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004089
4090
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004091http-check send-state
4092 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4094 yes | no | yes | yes
4095 Arguments : none
4096
4097 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4098 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4099 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4100 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4101 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4102
4103 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4104 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4105 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4106 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4107 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004108 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4109 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4110 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4111
4112 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4113 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4114 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4115
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004116 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4117 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4118 checked in multiple backends.
4119
4120 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4121 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4122
4123 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4124 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4125 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4126 one fails.
4127
4128 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4129 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4130 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4131
4132 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4133 server's queue.
4134
4135 Example of a header received by the application server :
4136 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4137 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4138
4139 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004141
4142http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004143 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4144
4145 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4146 no | yes | yes | yes
4147
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004148 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4149 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4150 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4151 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4152 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4155 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004157 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004159 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4160 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4161 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4162 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004164 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4165 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4166 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4167 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004169 Example:
4170 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4171 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4172 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174 http-request allow if nagios
4175 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4176 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4177 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 Example:
4180 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4181 acl add path /addacl
4182 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004184 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004185
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004186 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4187 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 Example:
4190 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4191 acl setmap path /setmap
4192 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004194 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4197 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004198
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004199 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4200 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004202http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4205 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4206 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4207 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4208 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4209 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4210 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4211 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004213http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4216 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4217 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4218 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4219 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4220 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4221 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4222 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004224http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4227 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004228
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4233 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4234 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4235 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4236 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004238 Example:
4239 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4240 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004241
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004242http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004244 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4247 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4250 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4251 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4252 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4253 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4254 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4255 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4256 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4257 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4260 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4261 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4262 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4263 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4264 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4269 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4270 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4271 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4272 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4273 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004275http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004277 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4282 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4283 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4284 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4285 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4286 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004289
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004290 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4291 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4292 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4293 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4294 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004295
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004296http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4297
4298 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4299 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4300 pointed by <resolvers>.
4301 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4302 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4303 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4304 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4305 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4306 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4307 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4308 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4309 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4310 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4311 to 0.0.0.0.
4312
4313 Example:
4314 resolvers mydns
4315 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4316 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4317 timeout retry 1s
4318 hold valid 10s
4319 hold nx 3s
4320 hold other 3s
4321 hold obsolete 0s
4322 accepted_payload_size 8192
4323
4324 frontend fe
4325 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4326 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4327 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4328
4329 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4330 # which mean DNS resolution error
4331 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4332
4333 default_backend be
4334
4335 backend b_503
4336 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4337 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4338 # 503 error page to end users
4339
4340 backend be
4341 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4342 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4343 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4344 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4345 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4346
4347 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4348 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4349
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004350http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4351
4352 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4353 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4354 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4355 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004356 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4357 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004358
4359 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4364 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4365 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4366 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4367 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4372 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4373 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4374 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004378
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004379 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4380 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4381 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4382 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4383 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4384 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4385 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4386 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004388 Example:
4389 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391 # applied to:
4392 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394 # outputs:
4395 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004399http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4400 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004401
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004402 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4403 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4404 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4405 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407 Example:
4408 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004410 # applied to:
4411 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413 # outputs:
4414 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4417http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004419 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4420 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4421 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004425 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4426 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4427 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4432 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4433 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4434 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4435 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437 Arguments:
4438 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4439 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004441 Example:
4442 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4443 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4446 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004448http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4451 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4452 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454 Arguments:
4455 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4456 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458 Example:
4459 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4460 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4463 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4464 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004466http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004468 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4469 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4470 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4471 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4472 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004474 Example:
4475 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4476 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4477 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4478 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4479 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4480 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4481 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4482 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4483 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004484
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004485http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004487 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4488 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4489 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4490 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4491 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4494 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4497 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4498 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4499 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4500 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4501 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4502 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4503 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4504 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004506http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4509 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4510 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4511 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4512 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4513 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4514 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004515
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004516http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004518 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4519 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4520 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004524 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4525 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4526 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4527 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4528 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4529 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4530 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4531 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004533http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4536 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4537 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4538 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4539 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4540 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542 Example :
4543 # prepend the host name before the path
4544 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004548 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4549 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4550 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4551 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4552 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004554http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004556 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4557 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4558 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4559 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4560 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4561 values have higher priority.
4562 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4563 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4564 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4565 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4566 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004568http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004570 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4571 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4572 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4573 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4574 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4575 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4576 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004578 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004579
4580 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004581 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4582 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004584http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4585 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4586 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4587 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4588 privacy.
4589
4590 Arguments :
4591 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4592 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004593
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004594 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004595 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4596 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4597
4598 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4599 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4600
4601http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4602
4603 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4604 expression.
4605
4606 Arguments:
4607 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4608 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004609
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004610 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4612 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4613
4614 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4615 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4616 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4617
4618http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4619
4620 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4621 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4622 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4623 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4624 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4625 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4626 information from the request.
4627
4628 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4629
4630http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4631
4632 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4633 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4634 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4635 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4636 path and the query string.
4637 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4638
4639http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4640
4641 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4642 inline.
4643
4644 Arguments:
4645 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4646 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4647 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4648 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4649 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4650 (request and response)
4651 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4652 processing
4653 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4654 processing
4655 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4656 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4657 and '_'.
4658
4659 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4660 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004661
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004662 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4666 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4669 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4670 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4671 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4672 agent name must be used.
4673
4674 Arguments:
4675 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4676
4677 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4678 configuration.
4679
4680http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4681
4682 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4683 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4684 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4685 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4686 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4687 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4688 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4689 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4690 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4691 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4692 action.
4693 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4694 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4695 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4696 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4697 you fully understand how it works.
4698
4699http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4700
4701 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4702 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4703 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4704 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4705 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4706 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4707 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4708 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4709 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4710 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4711 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4712 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4713 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4714
4715http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4716http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4717http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4718
4719 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4720 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4721 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4722 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4723 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4724 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4725 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4726 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4727 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4728 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4729 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4730 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4731
4732 Arguments :
4733 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4734 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4735 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4736 select which table entry to update the counters.
4737
4738 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4739 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4740 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4741 that table until the session ends.
4742
4743 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4744 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4745 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4746 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4747 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4748 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4749 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4750 useful information.
4751
4752 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4753 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4754 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4755 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4756 checks that make use of it.
4757
4758http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4759
4760 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004761
4762 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004763 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004765http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4768 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4769 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004770
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004772http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004773 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4774
4775 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 no | yes | yes | yes
4777
4778 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4779 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4780 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4781 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4782 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4783 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004785 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4786 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004788 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004790 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4791 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4792 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4793 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004795 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4796 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4797 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4798 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004800 Example:
4801 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004803 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004805 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4806 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004808 Example:
4809 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004811 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004813 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4814 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004816 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4817 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004819http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004821 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4822 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4823 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4824 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4825 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4826 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4827 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4828 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004832 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4833 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4834 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4835 example, or to pass some internal information.
4836 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4837 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4838 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004841
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004842 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4843 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004844
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004845http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004847 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004849http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004851 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4852 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4853 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4854 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4855 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4856 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4857 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004859 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4860 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4861 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4862 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4863 keyword.
4864 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4865 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004868
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004869 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4870 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4871 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4872 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4873 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4874 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004875
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004876http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004878 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4883 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4884 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4885 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4886 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4887 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004889http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004890
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004891 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4892 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004894http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004896 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4897 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4898 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4899 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4900 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4901 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4904 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4907 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4908 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4909 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4910 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4911 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4912 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4913 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004915 Example:
4916 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004918 # applied to:
4919 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004921 # outputs:
4922 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004924 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004926http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4927 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004929 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4930 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4931 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4932 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004934 Example:
4935 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 # applied to:
4938 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004940 # outputs:
4941 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004943http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4944http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4947 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4948 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004952 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4953 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4954 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004958 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4959 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4960 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4961 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4962 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964 Arguments:
4965 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004967 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4968 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004970http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4973 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4974 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4977
4978 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4979 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4980 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4981 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4982 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4983
4984http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4985
4986 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4987 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4988 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4989 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4990 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4991 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4992 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4993 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4994 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4995
4996http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4997
4998 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4999 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5000 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5001 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5002 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5003 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5004 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5005
5006http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5007
5008 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5009 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5010 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5011 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5012 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5013 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5014 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5015 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5016
5017http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5018 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5019
5020 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5021 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5022 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5023 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005024
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005025 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005026 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5027 http-response set-status 431
5028 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5029 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5034 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5035 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5036 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5037 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5038 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5039 based on some information from the request.
5040
5041 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5042
5043http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5044
5045 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5046 inline.
5047
5048 Arguments:
5049 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5050 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5051 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5052 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5053 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5054 (request and response)
5055 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5056 processing
5057 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5058 processing
5059 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5060 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5061 and '_'.
5062
5063 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5064 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005065
5066 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5072 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5073 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5074 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5075 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5076 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5077 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5078 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5079 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5080 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5081 action.
5082 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5083 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5084 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5085 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5086 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005088http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5089http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5090http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005092 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5093 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5094 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5095 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5096 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5097 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5098
5099http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5100
5101 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5102 about <var-name>.
5103
5104 Example:
5105 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5106
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005107
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005108http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5109 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5110
5111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5112 yes | no | yes | yes
5113
5114 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005115 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5116 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5117 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005118
5119 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5120
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005121 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5122 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5123 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5124 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5125 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5126 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5127 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5128 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5129 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5130 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005131
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005132 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5133 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5134 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5135 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5136 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5137 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5138 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5139 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005140
5141 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5142 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5143 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5144 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5145 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5146 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5147 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5148 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5149 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5150 downsides of rare connection failures.
5151
5152 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5153 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5154 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5155 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5156 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5157 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005158 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005159 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5160 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5161 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5162 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5163 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5164
5165 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005166 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5167 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5168 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005169
5170 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005171 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005172
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005173 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5174 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005175
5176 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5177 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5178 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5179
5180 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5181 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5182 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5183
5184 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5185
5186
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005187http-send-name-header [<header>]
5188 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5189
5190 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | no | yes | yes
5192
5193 Arguments :
5194
5195 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5196
5197 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005198 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005199 is added with the header string proved.
5200
5201 See also : "server"
5202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005203id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005204 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 no | yes | yes | yes
5207 Arguments : none
5208
5209 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5210 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5211 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005212
5213
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005214ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5215 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005217 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005218
5219 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5220 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5221 and running).
5222
5223 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5224 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5225 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005226 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005227 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5228
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005229 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5230 "unless" condition is met.
5231
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005232 Example:
5233 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5234 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5235 ignore-persist if url_static
5236
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005237 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5238
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005239load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5240 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 yes | no | yes | yes
5243
5244 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5245 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5246 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005247 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005248 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5249 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5250 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5251 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5252
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005253 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005254 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005255 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005256
5257 Arguments:
5258 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5259 named "server-state-file".
5260
5261 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5262 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5263 name is used as a file name.
5264
5265 none don't load any stat for this backend
5266
5267 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005268 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5269 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5270 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005271 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005272 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005273
5274 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5275 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5276
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005277 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005278
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005279 global
5280 stats socket /tmp/socket
5281 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005282
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005283 defaults
5284 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005285
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005286 backend bk
5287 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5288 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005289
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005290
5291 Then one can run :
5292
5293 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5294
5295 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5296
5297 1
5298 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5299 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5300 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5301
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005302 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005303
5304 global
5305 stats socket /tmp/socket
5306 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5307
5308 defaults
5309 load-server-state-from-file local
5310
5311 backend bk
5312 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5313 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5314
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005315
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005316 Then one can run :
5317
5318 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5319
5320 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5321
5322 1
5323 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5324 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5325 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5326
5327 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5328 "show servers state"
5329
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005330
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005331log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005332log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5333 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005334no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005335 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5337 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005338
5339 Prefix :
5340 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5341 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5342 prefix does not allow arguments.
5343
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005344 Arguments :
5345 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5346 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5347 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5348 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5349 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5350 parameter.
5351
5352 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5353 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5354
5355 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5356 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5357 standard syslog port).
5358
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005359 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5360 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5361 standard syslog port).
5362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005363 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5364 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5365 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005366 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005367
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005368 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5369 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5370 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5371 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5372 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5373 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5374 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5375 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5376 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5377 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5378 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5379 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5380 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5381 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5382 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5383 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005384 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5385 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005386
5387 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5388 and "fd@2", see above.
5389
5390 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5391 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005392
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005393 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5394 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5395 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5396 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5397 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5398 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5399 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5400 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5401 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5402 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005403 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005404
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005405 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5406 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5407 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5408 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5409 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5410
5411 <sample_size>
5412 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5413 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5414 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5415 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5416 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5417
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005418 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5419 one of the following :
5420
5421 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5422 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5423
5424 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5425 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5426
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005427 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5428 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5429 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5430 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5431 systemd logger consumes.
5432
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005433 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5434 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5435 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5436 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5437
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005438 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5439
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005440 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5441 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5442 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5443
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005444 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5445 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5446 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5447 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005448
5449 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5450 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5451 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005452 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5453 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5454 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5455 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5456 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005457
5458 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5459
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005460 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5461 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5462 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005463
5464 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5465 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5466 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5467 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5468
5469 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5470 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005471
5472 Example :
5473 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005474 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5475 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5476 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005477 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5478 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005479 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005480
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005481
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005482log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005483 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5485 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005486
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005487 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5488 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5489 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5490 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5491 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005492
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005493 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5494 "option httplog" directives.
5495
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005496log-format-sd <string>
5497 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5498 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 yes | yes | yes | no
5500
5501 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5502 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5503 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5504 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5505 which covers the log format string in depth.
5506
5507 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5508 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5509
5510 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5511 log format to "rfc5424".
5512
5513 Example :
5514 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5515
5516
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005517log-tag <string>
5518 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5520 yes | yes | yes | yes
5521
5522 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5523 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5524 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5525 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5526 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5527 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5528 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5529 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5530 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005531
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005532max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5533 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5535 yes | no | yes | yes
5536
5537 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5538 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5539 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5540 servers.
5541
5542 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5543 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5544 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5545 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5546 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005547 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005548 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5549 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5550 picking a different server.
5551
5552 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5553 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5554 even if they have to be queued.
5555
5556 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5557 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5558
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005559max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5560 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5561 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5562 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005563
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005564maxconn <conns>
5565 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | yes | yes | no
5568 Arguments :
5569 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5570 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5571 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5572 closes.
5573
5574 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5575 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5576 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5577 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005578 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5579 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5580 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5581 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005582
5583 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5584 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5585 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5586
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005587 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5588 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005590 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5591
5592
5593mode { tcp|http|health }
5594 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5596 yes | yes | yes | yes
5597 Arguments :
5598 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5599 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5600 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5601 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5602
5603 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5604 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5605 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5606 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5607 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5608
5609 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005610 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5611 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5612 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5613 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5614 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5615 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5616 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005617
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005618 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5619 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5620 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005621
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005622 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005623 defaults http_instances
5624 mode http
5625
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005626 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005628
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005629monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005630 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5632 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005633 Arguments :
5634 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5635 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005636 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005637 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5638 backend and its backup.
5639
5640 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5641 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5642 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5643 servers in a list of backends.
5644
5645 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5646 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5647 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5648 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5649 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5650 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5651 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005652 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5653 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005654
5655 Example:
5656 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005657 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005658 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5659 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5660 monitor-uri /site_alive
5661 monitor fail if site_dead
5662
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005663 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005664
5665
5666monitor-net <source>
5667 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5669 yes | yes | yes | no
5670 Arguments :
5671 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5672 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5673 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5674 followed by a mask.
5675
5676 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5677 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005678 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005679 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5680
5681 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5682 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5683 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5684 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005685 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5686 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5687 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005688
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005689 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5690 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5691 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5692 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5693 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5694 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005695
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005696 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5697 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005698
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699 Example :
5700 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5701 frontend www
5702 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5703
5704 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5705
5706
5707monitor-uri <uri>
5708 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 yes | yes | yes | no
5711 Arguments :
5712 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5713 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5714
5715 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5716 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5717 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5718 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5719 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5720 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5721 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5722 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5723
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005724 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5725 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5726 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5727 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5728 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5729 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5730 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5731 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005732
5733 Example :
5734 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5735 frontend www
5736 mode http
5737 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5738
5739 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005741
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005742option abortonclose
5743no option abortonclose
5744 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5746 yes | no | yes | yes
5747 Arguments : none
5748
5749 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5750 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5751 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5752 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005753 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005754 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5755 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5756 encountered while delivering the response.
5757
5758 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5759 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5760 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5761 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5762 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5763 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005764 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005765 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005766 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005767 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5768 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5769 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005771 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5772 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005773 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5774 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5775 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5776 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5777 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5778 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005779 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005780
5781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5783
5784 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5785
5786
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005787option accept-invalid-http-request
5788no option accept-invalid-http-request
5789 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5791 yes | yes | yes | no
5792 Arguments : none
5793
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005794 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005795 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005796 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005797 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5798 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5799 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5800 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5801 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005802 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5803 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5804 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5805 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005806 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005807 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005808 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5809 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5810 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005811
5812 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5813 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5814 been confirmed.
5815
5816 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5817 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005818 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5819 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005820 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5821
5822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5824
5825 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5826 stats socket.
5827
5828
5829option accept-invalid-http-response
5830no option accept-invalid-http-response
5831 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5833 yes | no | yes | yes
5834 Arguments : none
5835
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005836 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005837 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005838 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005839 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5840 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5841 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5842 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5843 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005844 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5845 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5846 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005847
5848 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5849 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5850 been confirmed.
5851
5852 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5853 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5854 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5855 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5856
5857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5859
5860 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5861 stats socket.
5862
5863
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005864option allbackups
5865no option allbackups
5866 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 yes | no | yes | yes
5869 Arguments : none
5870
5871 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5872 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5873 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5874 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5875 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5876 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5877 order between the backup servers anymore.
5878
5879 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5880 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5881
5882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5884
5885
5886option checkcache
5887no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005888 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5890 yes | no | yes | yes
5891 Arguments : none
5892
5893 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5894 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005895 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005896 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5897 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005898 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005899
5900 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005901 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005902 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005903 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5904 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005905 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005906 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005907 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5908 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005909 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005910 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5911 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005912 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005913 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5914 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5915 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5916 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5917 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5918 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5919 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5920 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5921 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5922
5923 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005924 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005925 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005926 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005927 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5928
5929 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5930 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005931 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005932 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005933
5934 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5935 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5936
5937
5938option clitcpka
5939no option clitcpka
5940 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5942 yes | yes | yes | no
5943 Arguments : none
5944
5945 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5946 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005947 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005948 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5949
5950 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5951 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5952 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5953 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5954
5955 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5956 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5957 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5958 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5959 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5960
5961 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5962
5963 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5964 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5965 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5966
5967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5969
5970 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5971
5972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005973option contstats
5974 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 yes | yes | yes | no
5977 Arguments : none
5978
5979 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5980 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5981 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5982 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005983 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5984 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5985 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5986 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5987 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005988
5989
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005990option dontlog-normal
5991no option dontlog-normal
5992 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | yes | yes | no
5995 Arguments : none
5996
5997 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5998 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5999 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6000 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6001 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6002 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6003 logged.
6004
6005 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6006 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6007 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006009 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006010 logging.
6011
6012
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006013option dontlognull
6014no option dontlognull
6015 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 yes | yes | yes | no
6018 Arguments : none
6019
6020 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6021 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6022 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6023 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6024 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6025 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006026 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6027 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6028 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029
6030 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006031 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006032 would not be logged.
6033
6034 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6035 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6036
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006037 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6038 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006039
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006040
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006041option forceclose (deprecated)
6042no option forceclose (deprecated)
6043 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006044
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006045 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006046
6047
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006048option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006049 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6051 yes | yes | yes | yes
6052 Arguments :
6053 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6054 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006055 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006056 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006057
6058 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6059 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6060 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6061 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6062 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6063 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6064 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006065 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6066 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6067 possible that the client has already brought one.
6068
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006069 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006070 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006071 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006072 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006073 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006074 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006075
6076 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6077 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6078 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6079 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6080 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6081 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6082 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6083
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006084 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6085 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6086 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6087 are under the control of the end-user.
6088
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006089 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006090 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6091 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006092 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6093 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6094 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006095
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006096 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006097 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6098 frontend www
6099 mode http
6100 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6101
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006102 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6103 backend www
6104 mode http
6105 option forwardfor header X-Client
6106
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006107 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006108 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006109
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006110
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006111option http-buffer-request
6112no option http-buffer-request
6113 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6115 yes | yes | yes | yes
6116 Arguments : none
6117
6118 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6119 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6120 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6121 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6122 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6123 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6124 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6125 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006126 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006127 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6128 default.
6129
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006130 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006131
6132
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006133option http-ignore-probes
6134no option http-ignore-probes
6135 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6137 yes | yes | yes | no
6138 Arguments : none
6139
6140 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6141 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6142 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6143 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6144 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6145 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6146 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6147 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6148 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006149 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6150 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006151 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6152
6153 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6154 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6155 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6156 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6157 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6158 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6159 are often the only way to detect them.
6160
6161 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6162 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6163
6164 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6165
6166
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006167option http-keep-alive
6168no option http-keep-alive
6169 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6171 yes | yes | yes | yes
6172 Arguments : none
6173
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006174 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6175 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006176 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6177 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6178 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6179 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6180 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006181
6182 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6183 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006184 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6185 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6186 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6187 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6188 situations where this option may be useful :
6189
6190 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006191 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006192
6193 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6194 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6195
6196 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6197 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6198 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6199 request.
6200
6201 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6202 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006203 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6204 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6205 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006206
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006207 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6208 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6209 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6210 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6211 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6212 not set.
6213
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006214 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006215 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6216 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006217
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006218 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006219 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006220 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006221
6222
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006223option http-no-delay
6224no option http-no-delay
6225 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6227 yes | yes | yes | yes
6228 Arguments : none
6229
6230 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6231 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6232 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6233 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6234 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6235 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6236 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6237 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6238 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6239 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6240 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6241 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6242 affected.
6243
6244 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6245 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6246 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6247 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6248 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6249 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6250 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6251 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6252 latency environments.
6253
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006254 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6255
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006256
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006257option http-pretend-keepalive
6258no option http-pretend-keepalive
6259 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006261 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006262 Arguments : none
6263
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006264 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006265 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6266 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6267 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6268 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6269 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6270 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6271 consider the response complete.
6272
6273 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6274 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6275 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6276 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006277 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006278 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6279
6280 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6281 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6282 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6283 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6284 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6285 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6286 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6287
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006288 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6289 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6290 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6291 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6292 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6293 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006294
6295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6297
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006298 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006299 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006300
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006301
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006302option http-server-close
6303no option http-server-close
6304 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | yes | yes | yes
6307 Arguments : none
6308
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006309 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6310 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6311 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6312 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006313 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6314 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6315 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6316 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6317 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6318 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6319 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6320 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6321 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6322 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6323 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006324
6325 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6326 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6327 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6328 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006329 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6330 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006331
6332 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6333 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006334 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6335 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6336 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006337
6338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6340
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006341 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6342 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006343
6344
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006345option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6346no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6347 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006349 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006350 Arguments : none
6351
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006352 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6353 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6354 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6355
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006356 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6357 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6358 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6359 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006360 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006361
6362 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006363 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006364 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6365 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6366 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6367 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6368 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6369 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6370 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006371
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006372 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6373 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6374 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6375 backend.
6376
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6379
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006380 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6381 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006382
6383
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006384option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006385no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006386 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6388 yes | yes | yes | no
6389 Arguments : none
6390
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006391 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006392 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6393 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6394 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6395 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6396 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6397 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6398
6399 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6400 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006401 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6402 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6403 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006404
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006405 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6406 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6407 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6408 front of an existing proxy.
6409
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006410 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6411
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006412 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006413
6414
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006415option http-use-htx
6416no option http-use-htx
6417 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6419 yes | yes | yes | yes
6420 Arguments : none
6421
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006422 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006423 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006424 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6425 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6426 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6427 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6428 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006429
6430 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6431 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6432 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6433 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006434 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6435 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6436 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6437 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006438
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006439 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6440 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6441 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6442 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6443 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006444
6445 See also : "mode http"
6446
6447
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006448option httpchk
6449option httpchk <uri>
6450option httpchk <method> <uri>
6451option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6452 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | no | yes | yes
6455 Arguments :
6456 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6457 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6458 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6459 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6460 ones.
6461
6462 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6463 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6464 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6465
6466 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6467 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6468 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6469 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6470 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6471
6472 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6473 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6474 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6475 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6476 the lack of any response.
6477
6478 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6479
6480 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6481 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6482 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6483
6484 Examples :
6485 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6486 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6487 backend https_relay
6488 mode tcp
6489 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6490 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6491
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006492 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6493 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6494 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006495
6496
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006497option httpclose
6498no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006499 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6501 yes | yes | yes | yes
6502 Arguments : none
6503
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006504 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6505 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6506 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6507 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006508 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006509
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006510 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6511 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6512 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6513 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6514 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006515
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006516 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6517 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6518 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006519
6520 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6521 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006522 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006523 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6524 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6525 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006526
6527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6529
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006530 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006531
6532
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006533option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006534 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006536 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006537 Arguments :
6538 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6539 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6540 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006541 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006542 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006543
6544 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6545 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6546 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6547 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6548 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6549 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6550 ports.
6551
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006552 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6553 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006554
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006555 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006557 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006558
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006559
6560option http_proxy
6561no option http_proxy
6562 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6564 yes | yes | yes | yes
6565 Arguments : none
6566
6567 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6568 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6569 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6570 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6571 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6572
6573 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6574 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006575 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6576 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006577
6578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6580
6581 Example :
6582 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6583 backend direct_forward
6584 option httpclose
6585 option http_proxy
6586
6587 See also : "option httpclose"
6588
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006589
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006590option independent-streams
6591no option independent-streams
6592 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6594 yes | yes | yes | yes
6595 Arguments : none
6596
6597 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6598 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6599 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6600 receive data or not.
6601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006602 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006603 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6604 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6605 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6606 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6607 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6608 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6609 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6610 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6611 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6612 socket buffers.
6613
6614 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6615 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6616 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6617 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6618 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6619
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006620 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006621 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6622 deprecated.
6623
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006624 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006625
6626
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006627option ldap-check
6628 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6630 yes | no | yes | yes
6631 Arguments : none
6632
6633 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6634 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6635 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6636 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6637
6638 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6639 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6640
6641 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6642 configure it.
6643
6644 Example :
6645 option ldap-check
6646
6647 See also : "option httpchk"
6648
6649
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006650option external-check
6651 Use external processes for server health checks
6652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6653 yes | no | yes | yes
6654
6655 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6656 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6657 command".
6658
6659 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6660
6661 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6662
6663
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006664option log-health-checks
6665no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006666 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6668 yes | no | yes | yes
6669 Arguments : none
6670
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006671 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6672 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6673 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006674
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006675 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6676 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6677 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6678 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6679 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6680
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006681 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006682 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006683
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006684 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6685 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6686 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006687
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006688
6689option log-separate-errors
6690no option log-separate-errors
6691 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6693 yes | yes | yes | no
6694 Arguments : none
6695
6696 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6697 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6698 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6699 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6700 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6701 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6702 provides very important information.
6703
6704 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6705 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6706 error logs.
6707
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006708 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006709 logging.
6710
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006711
6712option logasap
6713no option logasap
6714 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6716 yes | yes | yes | no
6717 Arguments : none
6718
6719 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6720 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6721 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6722 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6723 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6724 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6725 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006726 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006727 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6728 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6729
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006730 Examples :
6731 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6732 mode http
6733 option httplog
6734 option logasap
6735 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6736
6737 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6738 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6739 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6740 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6741
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006742 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006743 logging.
6744
6745
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006746option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006747 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6749 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006750 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006751 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6752 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006753 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006754
6755 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6756 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006757 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006758 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6759 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6760 in the MySQL table, like this :
6761
6762 USE mysql;
6763 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6764 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6765
6766 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006767 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006768 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6769 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6770 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6771 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6772 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6773 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6774 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6775
6776 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6777 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006778
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006779 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006780
6781 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6782 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6783 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6784 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006785 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6786 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006787
6788 See also: "option httpchk"
6789
6790
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006791option nolinger
6792no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006793 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6795 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006796 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006797
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006798 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006799 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6800 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6801 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6802 connections.
6803
6804 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6805 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6806 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6807 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6808 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6809 this too.
6810
6811 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6812 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6813 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6814
6815 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6816 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6817 for servers.
6818
6819 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6820 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6821
6822
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006823option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6824 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6826 yes | yes | yes | yes
6827 Arguments :
6828 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6829 matching <network>
6830 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6831 header name.
6832
6833 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6834 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6835 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6836 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6837 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6838 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6839 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6840 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6841 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6842 possible that the client has already brought one.
6843
6844 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6845 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6846 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6847 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6848 header and requires different one.
6849
6850 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6851 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6852 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6853 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6854 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6855 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6856 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6857
6858 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6859 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6860 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6861 both are defined.
6862
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006863 Examples :
6864 # Original Destination address
6865 frontend www
6866 mode http
6867 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6868
6869 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6870 backend www
6871 mode http
6872 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6873
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006874 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006875
6876
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006877option persist
6878no option persist
6879 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006882 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006883
6884 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6885 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6886 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6887 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6888 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6889 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6890 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6891 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6892 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6893 redirected to another valid server.
6894
6895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6897
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006898 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006899
6900
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006901option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6902 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6904 yes | no | yes | yes
6905 Arguments :
6906 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6907 PostgreSQL server.
6908
6909 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6910 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6911 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6912 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6913
6914 See also: "option httpchk"
6915
6916
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006917option prefer-last-server
6918no option prefer-last-server
6919 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6920 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6921 yes | no | yes | yes
6922 Arguments : none
6923
6924 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6925 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6926 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6927 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6928 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6929 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6930 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6931 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6932 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006933 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6934 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006935 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6936 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6937 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006938 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6939 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6940 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006941
6942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6944
6945 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6946
6947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006948option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006949option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006950no option redispatch
6951 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6953 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006954 Arguments :
6955 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6956 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6957 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006958 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006959 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006960 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006961 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6962 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6963 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006965
6966 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6967 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6968 be able to access the service anymore.
6969
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006970 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6971 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006972
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006973 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006974 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6975 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006977 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6978 "redisp" keywords.
6979
6980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6982
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006983 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006984
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006985
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006986option redis-check
6987 Use redis health checks for server testing
6988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6989 yes | no | yes | yes
6990 Arguments : none
6991
6992 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6993 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6994 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6995 find the "+PONG" response message.
6996
6997 Example :
6998 option redis-check
6999
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007000 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007001
7002
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007003option smtpchk
7004option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7005 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7007 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007009 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007010 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007011 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7012
7013 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7014 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7015 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7016
7017 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7018 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7019 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7020 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7021 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7022 dead server.
7023
7024 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7025 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007026 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007027 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7028
7029 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7030 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7031 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7032 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007033 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007034
7035 Example :
7036 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7037
7038 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007041option socket-stats
7042no option socket-stats
7043
7044 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7046 yes | yes | yes | no
7047
7048 Arguments : none
7049
7050
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007051option splice-auto
7052no option splice-auto
7053 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7055 yes | yes | yes | yes
7056 Arguments : none
7057
7058 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7059 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007060 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007061 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007062 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007063 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7064 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7065 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7066 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7067
7068 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7069 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7070 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7071 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7072 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7073 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7074 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7075 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7076 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7077 keyword.
7078
7079 Example :
7080 option splice-auto
7081
7082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7084
7085 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7086 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7087
7088
7089option splice-request
7090no option splice-request
7091 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7093 yes | yes | yes | yes
7094 Arguments : none
7095
7096 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007097 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007098 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7099 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7100 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7101 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7102
7103 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7104
7105 Example :
7106 option splice-request
7107
7108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7110
7111 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7112 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7113
7114
7115option splice-response
7116no option splice-response
7117 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7119 yes | yes | yes | yes
7120 Arguments : none
7121
7122 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007123 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007124 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7125 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7126 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7127 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7128
7129 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7130
7131 Example :
7132 option splice-response
7133
7134 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7135 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7136
7137 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7138 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7139
7140
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007141option spop-check
7142 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7144 no | no | no | yes
7145 Arguments : none
7146
7147 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7148 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7149 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7150 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7151
7152 Example :
7153 option spop-check
7154
7155 See also : "option httpchk"
7156
7157
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007158option srvtcpka
7159no option srvtcpka
7160 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7162 yes | no | yes | yes
7163 Arguments : none
7164
7165 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7166 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007167 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007168 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7169
7170 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7171 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7172 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7173 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7174
7175 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7176 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7177 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7178 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7179 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7180
7181 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7182
7183 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7184 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7185 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7186
7187 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7188 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7189
7190 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7191
7192
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007193option ssl-hello-chk
7194 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7196 yes | no | yes | yes
7197 Arguments : none
7198
7199 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7200 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7201 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7202 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7203 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7204 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7205 hello message.
7206
7207 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7208 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7209 messages, which is appreciable.
7210
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007211 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7212 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7213 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007214
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007215 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7216
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007217
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007218option tcp-check
7219 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7221 yes | no | yes | yes
7222
7223 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7224 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7225
7226 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7227 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7228 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7229
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007230 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007231 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7232 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7233 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7234 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7235 only.
7236
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007237 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007238 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7239 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7240 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7241 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7242
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007243 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007244 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7245 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007246 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007247 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7248 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7249 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7250 the respective protocols.
7251 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007252 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007253
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007254 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7255 script.
7256
7257 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7258 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7259 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7260 The "comment" is of course optional.
7261
7262
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007263 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007264 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007265 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007266 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007267
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007268 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007269 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007270 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007271
7272 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7273 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007274 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007275 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007276 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007277 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007278 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007279 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007280 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7281 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007282 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007283 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7284 tcp-check expect string +OK
7285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007286 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007287 (send many headers before analyzing)
7288 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007289 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007290 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7291 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7292 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7293 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007294 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007295
7296
7297 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7298
7299
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007300option tcp-smart-accept
7301no option tcp-smart-accept
7302 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7304 yes | yes | yes | no
7305 Arguments : none
7306
7307 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7308 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7309 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7310 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7311 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7312 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7313
7314 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7315 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7316 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7317 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7318
7319 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7320 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7321 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007322 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007323
7324 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7325 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7326 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7327
7328 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7329 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7330 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7331
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007332 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7333
7334
7335option tcp-smart-connect
7336no option tcp-smart-connect
7337 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7339 yes | no | yes | yes
7340 Arguments : none
7341
7342 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7343 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7344 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7345 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7346 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7347
7348 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7349 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7350 complex.
7351
7352 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7353 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7354 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7355
7356 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7357 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7358
7359 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7360
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007361
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007362option tcpka
7363 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7365 yes | yes | yes | yes
7366 Arguments : none
7367
7368 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7369 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007370 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007371 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7372
7373 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7374 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7375 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7376 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7377
7378 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7379 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7380 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7381 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7382 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7383
7384 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7385
7386 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7387 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7388 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7389 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7390 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7391 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7392 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7393 backends.
7394
7395 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7396
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007397
7398option tcplog
7399 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007401 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007402 Arguments : none
7403
7404 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7405 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7406 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7407 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7408 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7409 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7410 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7411 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7412
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007413 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007415 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007416
7417
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007418option transparent
7419no option transparent
7420 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007422 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007423 Arguments : none
7424
7425 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7426 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7427 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7428 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7429 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7430 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7431 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7432 appropriate server.
7433
7434 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7435 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7436
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007437 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007438 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007439
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007440
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007441external-check command <command>
7442 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7444 yes | no | yes | yes
7445
7446 Arguments :
7447 <command> is the external command to run
7448
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007449 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7450
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007451 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007452
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007453 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7454 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7455 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7456 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7457 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7458 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007459
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007460 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7461
7462 Environment variables :
7463 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7464 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7465
7466 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7467
7468 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7469
7470 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7471 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7472 for a UNIX socket).
7473
7474 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7475
7476 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7477
7478 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7479
7480 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7481
7482 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7483
7484 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7485 socket).
7486
7487 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7488 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7489
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007490 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7491 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7492 failed.
7493
7494 Example :
7495 external-check command /bin/true
7496
7497 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7498
7499
7500external-check path <path>
7501 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7503 yes | no | yes | yes
7504
7505 Arguments :
7506 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7507
7508 The default path is "".
7509
7510 Example :
7511 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7512
7513 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7514 "external-check command"
7515
7516
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007517persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007518persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007519 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7521 yes | no | yes | yes
7522 Arguments :
7523 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007524 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7525 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007526
7527 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7528 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007529 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007530 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7531 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7532 forwarded to this server.
7533
7534 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7535 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7536 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007537 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007538 a single "listen" section.
7539
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007540 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7541 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7542 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7543
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007544 Example :
7545 listen tse-farm
7546 bind :3389
7547 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7548 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7549 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7550 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7551 persist rdp-cookie
7552 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007553 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007554 balance rdp-cookie
7555 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7556 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7557
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007558 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7559 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007560
7561
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007562rate-limit sessions <rate>
7563 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7565 yes | yes | yes | no
7566 Arguments :
7567 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7568 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7569
7570 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7571 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7572 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7573 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7574 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7575 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7576
7577 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7578 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7579 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7580 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7581
7582 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7583 listen smtp
7584 mode tcp
7585 bind :25
7586 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007587 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007588
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007589 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7590 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7591 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007592
7593 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7594
7595
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007596redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7597redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7598redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007599 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 no | yes | yes | yes
7602
7603 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007604 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007605
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007606 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007607 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007608 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7609 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7610 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007611
7612 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7613 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7614 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7615 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7616 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007617 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7618 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7619 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7620 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007621
7622 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7623 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7624 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7625 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7626 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7627 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007628 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007629 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007630 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7631 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7632 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007633
7634 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007635 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7636 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7637 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007638 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007639 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7640 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7641 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7642 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007643
7644 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007645 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007646
7647 - "drop-query"
7648 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7649 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7650 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7651 with a location-type redirect.
7652
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007653 - "append-slash"
7654 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7655 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7656 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7657 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7658
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007659 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7660 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7661 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7662 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7663 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7664 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7665 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7666
7667 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7668 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7669 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7670 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7671 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7672 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7673 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007674
7675 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7676 acl clear dst_port 80
7677 acl secure dst_port 8080
7678 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007679 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007680 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007681 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7682
7683 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007684 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7685 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7686 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007687 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007688
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007689 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7690 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7691 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7692
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007693 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007694 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007695
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007696 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007697 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7698 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7699 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007701 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007702
7703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007704redisp (deprecated)
7705redispatch (deprecated)
7706 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7708 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007709 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007710
7711 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7712 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7713 be able to access the service anymore.
7714
7715 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7716 redistribute them to a working server.
7717
7718 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7719 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7720 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007722 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7723 "option redispatch" instead.
7724
7725 See also : "option redispatch"
7726
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007727
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007728reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007729 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7731 no | yes | yes | yes
7732 Arguments :
7733 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7734 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007735 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007736
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007737 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7738 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7739
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007740 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7741 the last header of an HTTP request.
7742
7743 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7744 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7745 responses.
7746
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007747 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7748 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7749 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7750
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007751 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7752 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007753
7754
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007755reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7756reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007757 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 no | yes | yes | yes
7760 Arguments :
7761 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7762 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7763 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7764 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7765 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7766 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7767 ignores case.
7768
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007769 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7770 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7771
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007772 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7773 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7774 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7775 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007776 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007777
7778 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7779 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7780
7781 Example :
7782 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7783 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7784 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7785
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007786 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7787 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007788
7789
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007790reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7791reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007792 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7794 no | yes | yes | yes
7795 Arguments :
7796 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7797 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7798 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7799 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7800 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7801 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7802
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007803 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7804 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7805
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007806 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7807 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7808 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7809 next servers.
7810
7811 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7812 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7813 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7814
7815 Example :
7816 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7817 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7818 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7819
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007820 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7821 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007822
7823
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007824reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7825reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007826 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 no | yes | yes | yes
7829 Arguments :
7830 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7831 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7832 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7833 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7834 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7835 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7836 case.
7837
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007838 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7839 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7840
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007841 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7842 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7843 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7844 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007845 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007846
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007847 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007848 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007849 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007850
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007851 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7852 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7853
7854 Example :
7855 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7856 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7857 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7858
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007859 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7860 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007861
7862
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007863reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7864reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007865 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7867 no | yes | yes | yes
7868 Arguments :
7869 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7870 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7871 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7872 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7873 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7874 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7875 case.
7876
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007877 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7878 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7879
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007880 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7881 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7882 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7883 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7884
7885 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7886 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7887
7888 Example :
7889 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7890 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7891 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7892 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7893
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007894 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7895 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007896
7897
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007898reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7899reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007900 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7902 no | yes | yes | yes
7903 Arguments :
7904 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7905 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7906 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7907 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7908 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7909 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7910
7911 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7912 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7913 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7914 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007915 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007916
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007917 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7918 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7919
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007920 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7921 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7922 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7923
7924 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7925 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7926 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7927 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7928 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7929
7930 Example :
7931 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007932 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007933 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7934 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7935
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007936 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7937 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007938
7939
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007940reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7941reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007942 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7944 no | yes | yes | yes
7945 Arguments :
7946 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7947 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7948 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7949 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7950 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7951 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7952 ignores case.
7953
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007954 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7955 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7956
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007957 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7958 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007959 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7960 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7961 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007962 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7963 not set.
7964
7965 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7966 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7967 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7968 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7969 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7970
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007971 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007972 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007973 # block all others.
7974 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7975 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7976
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007977 # block bad guys
7978 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7979 reqitarpit . if badguys
7980
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007981 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7982 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007983
7984
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007985retries <value>
7986 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7988 yes | no | yes | yes
7989 Arguments :
7990 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7991 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7992 default value is 3.
7993
7994 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7995 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7996 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7997
7998 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007999 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8000 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008001
8002 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8003 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8004
8005 See also : "option redispatch"
8006
8007
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008008retry-on [list of keywords]
8009 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8011 yes | no | yes | yes
8012 Arguments :
8013 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8014 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8015 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8016 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8017
8018 none never retry
8019
8020 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8021 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8022
8023 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8024 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8025 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8026 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8027 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8028 processing the request.
8029
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008030 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8031 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8032 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8033 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8034 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8035 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8036 overflow attack for example).
8037
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008038 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8039 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8040 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8041 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8042 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8043 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8044 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8045 amplify denial of service attacks.
8046
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008047 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8048 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8049 considered to be safe to retry.
8050
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008051 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8052 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8053 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8054 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8055
8056 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8057 not cumulative.
8058
8059 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8060 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8061 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8062 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8063
8064 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8065 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8066 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8067 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8068 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8069 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8070 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8071 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8072 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8073 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8074 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8075 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8076
8077 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8078 should not use this directive.
8079
8080 The default is "conn-failure".
8081
8082 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8083
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008084rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008085 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8087 no | yes | yes | yes
8088 Arguments :
8089 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8090 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008091 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008092
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008093 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8094 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8095
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008096 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8097 the last header of an HTTP response.
8098
8099 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8100 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8101 responses.
8102
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008103 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8104 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008105
8106
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008107rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8108rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008109 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8111 no | yes | yes | yes
8112 Arguments :
8113 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8114 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8115 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8116 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8117 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8118 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8119 ignores case.
8120
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008121 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8122 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8123
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008124 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8125 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008126 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008127 client.
8128
8129 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8130 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8131 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8132
8133 Example :
8134 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008135 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008136
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008137 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8138 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008139
8140
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008141rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8142rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008143 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8145 no | yes | yes | yes
8146 Arguments :
8147 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8148 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8149 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8150 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8151 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8152 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8153 ignores case.
8154
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008155 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8156 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8157
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008158 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8159 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8160 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8161 case-sensitive.
8162
8163 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008164 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8165 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8166 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008167
8168 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8169 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8170
8171 Example :
8172 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8173 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8174
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008175 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8176 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008177
8178
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008179rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8180rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008181 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8183 no | yes | yes | yes
8184 Arguments :
8185 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8186 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8187 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8188 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8189 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8190 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8191 ignores case.
8192
8193 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8194 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8195 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8196 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008197 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008198
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008199 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8200 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8201
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008202 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8203 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8204 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8205
8206 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8207 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8208 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8209 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8210 are not case-sensitive.
8211
8212 Example :
8213 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8214 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8215
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008216 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8217 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008218
8219
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008220server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008221 Declare a server in a backend
8222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8223 no | no | yes | yes
8224 Arguments :
8225 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008226 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008227 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008228
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008229 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8230 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8231 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8232 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008233 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8234 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8235 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8236 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8237 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008238 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8239 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8240 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8241 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8242 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8243 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8244 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008245 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008246 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8247 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8248 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8249 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8250 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8251 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008252 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8253 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008254 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8255 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008256
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008257 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008258 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8259 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8260 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8261 adding this value to the client's port.
8262
8263 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8264 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008265 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008266
8267 Examples :
8268 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8269 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008270 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008271 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8272 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8273 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008274
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008275 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8276 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8277 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8278 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8279 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8280
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008281 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8282 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008283
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008284server-state-file-name [<file>]
8285 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8286 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8287 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8288 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8289 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8290 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8291
8292 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8293 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8294
8295 global
8296 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8297
8298 backend bk
8299 load-server-state-from-file
8300
8301 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8302 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008303
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008304server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8305 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8306 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8308 no | no | yes | yes
8309
8310 Arguments:
8311 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8312
8313 <num | range>
8314 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8315 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8316 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8317 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8318
8319 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8320
8321 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8322
8323 <params*>
8324 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8325 keyword.
8326
8327 Examples:
8328 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8329 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8330 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8331
8332 # or
8333 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8334
8335 # would be equivalent to:
8336 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8337 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8338 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8339
8340
8341
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008342source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008343source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008344source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008345 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8347 yes | no | yes | yes
8348 Arguments :
8349 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8350 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008351
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008352 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008353 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8354 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8355 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8356 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8357 supported prefixes are :
8358 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8359 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8360 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008361 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008362 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8363 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008364
8365 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8366 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008367 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8368 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8369 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008370
8371 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8372 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8373 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8374 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8375 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8376 <addr>.
8377
8378 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8379 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8380 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8381 port.
8382
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008383 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8384 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8385 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8386 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008387 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008388 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8389 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8390 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8391 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8392 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8393 HTTP header.
8394
8395 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8396 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008397 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008398 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8399 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8400 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8401 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8402 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8403 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8404 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8405
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008406 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8407 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8408 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8409 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8410 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8411 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8412
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008413 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8414 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8415 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8416 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8417
8418 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8419 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8420 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8421 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8422 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8423 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8424
8425 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8426 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8427 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8428 there are two methods :
8429
8430 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8431 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8432 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8433 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8434 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8435 of the client ranges may be used.
8436
8437 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8438 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8439 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8440 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8441 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8442 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8443 same session.
8444
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008445 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8446 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8447 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008448 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008449
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008450 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8451
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008452 Examples :
8453 backend private
8454 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8455 source 192.168.1.200
8456
8457 backend transparent_ssl1
8458 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8459 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8460
8461 backend transparent_ssl2
8462 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8463 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8464 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8465
8466 backend transparent_ssl3
8467 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8468 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8469 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8470
8471 backend transparent_smtp
8472 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8473 # with Tproxy version 4.
8474 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8475
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008476 backend transparent_http
8477 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8478 # proxy.
8479 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8480
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008481 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008482 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008484
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008485srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8486 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8488 yes | no | yes | yes
8489 Arguments :
8490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8492 as explained at the top of this document.
8493
8494 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8495 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8496 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8497 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8498 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8499 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8500 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8501
8502 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8503 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8504 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8505 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8506 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008507 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008508 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008509 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008510
8511 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8512 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8513 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8514 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8515 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8516 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8517
8518 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8519 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8520
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008521 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8522 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008523
8524
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008525stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8526 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008528 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008529
8530 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8531 matched.
8532
8533 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8534 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8535
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008536 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8537 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008538 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008539
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008540 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8541 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8542 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8543 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008544
8545 Example :
8546 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8547 backend stats_localhost
8548 stats enable
8549 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8550
8551 Example :
8552 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8553 backend stats_auth
8554 stats enable
8555 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8556 stats admin if TRUE
8557
8558 Example :
8559 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8560 userlist stats-auth
8561 group admin users admin
8562 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8563 group readonly users haproxy
8564 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8565
8566 backend stats_auth
8567 stats enable
8568 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8569 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8570 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8571 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8572
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008573 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8574 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8575 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008576
8577
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008578stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8579 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008581 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008582 Arguments :
8583 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8584
8585 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8586
8587 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8588 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8589 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8590 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8591 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8592 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8593
8594 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8595 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8596 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008597 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008598
8599 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8600 report using "stats scope".
8601
8602 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8603 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8604 unobvious parameters.
8605
8606 Example :
8607 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8608 backend public_www
8609 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8610 stats enable
8611 stats hide-version
8612 stats scope .
8613 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008614 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008615 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8616 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8617
8618 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8619 backend private_monitoring
8620 stats enable
8621 stats uri /admin?stats
8622 stats refresh 5s
8623
8624 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8625
8626
8627stats enable
8628 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008630 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008631 Arguments : none
8632
8633 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8634 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8635 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8636 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8637 - stats auth : no authentication
8638 - stats scope : no restriction
8639
8640 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8641 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8642 unobvious parameters.
8643
8644 Example :
8645 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8646 backend public_www
8647 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8648 stats enable
8649 stats hide-version
8650 stats scope .
8651 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008652 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008653 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8654 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8655
8656 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8657 backend private_monitoring
8658 stats enable
8659 stats uri /admin?stats
8660 stats refresh 5s
8661
8662 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8663
8664
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008665stats hide-version
8666 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008668 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008669 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008670
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008671 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8672 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8673 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8674 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8675 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8676 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008678 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8679 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8680 unobvious parameters.
8681
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008682 Example :
8683 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8684 backend public_www
8685 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008686 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008687 stats hide-version
8688 stats scope .
8689 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008690 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008691 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8692 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008693
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008694 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8695 backend private_monitoring
8696 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008697 stats uri /admin?stats
8698 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008699
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008700 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008701
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008702
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008703stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8704 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8705 Access control for statistics
8706
8707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8708 no | no | yes | yes
8709
8710 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8711 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8712 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8713 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8714 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8715 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8716
8717 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8718 instance.
8719
8720 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8721 about ACL usage.
8722
8723
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008724stats realm <realm>
8725 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008727 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008728 Arguments :
8729 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8730 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8731 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8732
8733 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8734 using a backslash ('\').
8735
8736 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8737 only related to authentication.
8738
8739 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8740 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8741 unobvious parameters.
8742
8743 Example :
8744 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8745 backend public_www
8746 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8747 stats enable
8748 stats hide-version
8749 stats scope .
8750 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008751 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008752 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8753 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8754
8755 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8756 backend private_monitoring
8757 stats enable
8758 stats uri /admin?stats
8759 stats refresh 5s
8760
8761 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8762
8763
8764stats refresh <delay>
8765 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008767 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008768 Arguments :
8769 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8770 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8771 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8772 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8773 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8774 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8775
8776 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8777 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8778 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8779 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8780
8781 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8782 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8783 unobvious parameters.
8784
8785 Example :
8786 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8787 backend public_www
8788 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8789 stats enable
8790 stats hide-version
8791 stats scope .
8792 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008793 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008794 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8795 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8796
8797 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8798 backend private_monitoring
8799 stats enable
8800 stats uri /admin?stats
8801 stats refresh 5s
8802
8803 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8804
8805
8806stats scope { <name> | "." }
8807 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008809 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008810 Arguments :
8811 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8812 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8813 section in which the statement appears.
8814
8815 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8816 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8817 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8818 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8819 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8820 exists.
8821
8822 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8823 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8824 unobvious parameters.
8825
8826 Example :
8827 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8828 backend public_www
8829 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8830 stats enable
8831 stats hide-version
8832 stats scope .
8833 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008834 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008835 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8836 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8837
8838 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8839 backend private_monitoring
8840 stats enable
8841 stats uri /admin?stats
8842 stats refresh 5s
8843
8844 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8845
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008846
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008847stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008848 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008850 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008851
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008852 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008853 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8854
8855 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8856 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8857
8858 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8859 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008860 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008861
8862 Example :
8863 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8864 backend private_monitoring
8865 stats enable
8866 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8867 stats uri /admin?stats
8868 stats refresh 5s
8869
8870 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8871 global section.
8872
8873
8874stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008875 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8877 yes | yes | yes | yes
8878 Arguments : none
8879
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008880 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008881 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8882 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8883 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8884 - IP (socket, server)
8885 - cookie (backend, server)
8886
8887 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8888 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008889 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008890
8891 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8892
8893
8894stats show-node [ <name> ]
8895 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008897 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008898 Arguments:
8899 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8900 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8901
8902 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8903 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008904 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008905
8906 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8907 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8908 unobvious parameters.
8909
8910 Example:
8911 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8912 backend private_monitoring
8913 stats enable
8914 stats show-node Europe-1
8915 stats uri /admin?stats
8916 stats refresh 5s
8917
8918 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8919 section.
8920
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008921
8922stats uri <prefix>
8923 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008925 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008926 Arguments :
8927 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8928 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8929 query string.
8930
8931 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8932 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8933 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8934 possible to reach it in the application.
8935
8936 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008937 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008938 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8939 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8940 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8941 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8942
8943 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8944 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8945 an address or a port to statistics only.
8946
8947 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8948 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8949 unobvious parameters.
8950
8951 Example :
8952 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8953 backend public_www
8954 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8955 stats enable
8956 stats hide-version
8957 stats scope .
8958 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008959 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008960 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8961 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8962
8963 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8964 backend private_monitoring
8965 stats enable
8966 stats uri /admin?stats
8967 stats refresh 5s
8968
8969 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8970
8971
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008972stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8973 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008975 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008976
8977 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008978 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008979 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008980 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008981 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8982
8983 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8984 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8985 the "stick-table" statement.
8986
8987 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8988 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8989 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8990 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8991 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8992
8993 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8994 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8995 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8996 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8997 transformation rules.
8998
8999 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9000 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9001 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9002 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9003 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9004 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9005 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9006
9007 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9008 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9009 ACL based conditions.
9010
9011 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9012 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9013 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9014 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9015
9016 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9017 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9018 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9019 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9020
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009021 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9022 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009023 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009024
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009025 Example :
9026 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9027 # last 30 minutes
9028 backend pop
9029 mode tcp
9030 balance roundrobin
9031 stick store-request src
9032 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9033 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9034 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9035
9036 backend smtp
9037 mode tcp
9038 balance roundrobin
9039 stick match src table pop
9040 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9041 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9042
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009043 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009044 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009045
9046
9047stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9048 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9050 no | no | yes | yes
9051
9052 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9053 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9054 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9055 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9056
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009057 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9058 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009059 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009060
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009061 Examples :
9062 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009063 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009064
9065 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9066 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9067 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9068
9069
9070 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9071 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9072 backend http
9073 mode http
9074 balance roundrobin
9075 stick on src table https
9076 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9077 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9078 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9079
9080 backend https
9081 mode tcp
9082 balance roundrobin
9083 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9084 stick on src
9085 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9086 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9087
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009088 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009089
9090
9091stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9092 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9094 no | no | yes | yes
9095
9096 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009097 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009098 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009099 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009100 server is selected.
9101
9102 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9103 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9104 the "stick-table" statement.
9105
9106 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9107 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9108 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9109 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9110 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9111 address.
9112
9113 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9114 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9115 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9116 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9117 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9118 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9119 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9120 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9121 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9122 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9123
9124 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9125 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9126 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9127 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9128 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9129 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9130 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9131
9132 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9133 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9134 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9135 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9136
9137 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9138 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9139 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9140 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9141 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9142 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009143 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9144 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9145 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9146 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9147 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9148 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009149
9150 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9151 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9152 the request.
9153
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009154 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9155 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009156 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009157
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009158 Example :
9159 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9160 # last 30 minutes
9161 backend pop
9162 mode tcp
9163 balance roundrobin
9164 stick store-request src
9165 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9166 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9167 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9168
9169 backend smtp
9170 mode tcp
9171 balance roundrobin
9172 stick match src table pop
9173 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9174 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9175
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009176 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009177 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009178
9179
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009180stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009181 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9182 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009183 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009185 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009186
9187 Arguments :
9188 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9189 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9190 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9191 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9192
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009193 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9194 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9195 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9196 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9197
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009198 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9199 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9200 instance.
9201
9202 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9203 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9204 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9205 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9206 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9207 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009208 to 32 characters.
9209
9210 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9211 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9212 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009213 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009214 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9215 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009216
9217 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009218 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9219 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009220 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9221 increase.
9222
9223 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009224 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9225 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9226 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009227
9228 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9229 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9230 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9231 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009232 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009233 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9234 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9235 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9236 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9237 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9238 parameter (see below).
9239
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009240 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9241 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9242 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9243 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9244 soft restart.
9245
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009246 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9247 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009248
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009249 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9250 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9251 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9252 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009253 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009254 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009255 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9256 if not expiration delay is specified.
9257
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009258 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9259 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9260 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9261 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009262 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9263 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9264 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9265 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9266 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9267 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9268 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9269 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9270 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9271 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9272 types and their arguments.
9273
9274 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9275 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9276 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9277 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9278
9279 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9280 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9281 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009282 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009283
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009284 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9285 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9286 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009287 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009288 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009289 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009290
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009291 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9292 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9293 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9294 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9295
9296 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9297 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9298 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9299 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9300 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9301 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9302
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009303 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9304 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9305 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9306 they were received.
9307
9308 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9309 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9310 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9311 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9312 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9313
9314 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9315 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9316 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9317 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9318 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9319
9320 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9321 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9322 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9323
9324 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9325 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9326 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9327 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9328 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9329
9330 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9331 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9332 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9333 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9334 the client side.
9335
9336 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9337 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9338 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9339 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9340 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9341 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9342 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9343
9344 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9345 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9346 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9347 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9348 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9349 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009350 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009351
9352 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9353 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9354 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9355 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9356 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9357 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9358
9359 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009360 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009361 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9362 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9363
9364 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9365 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9366 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9367 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9368 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9369 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9370 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9371 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9372 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9373 recommended for better fairness.
9374
9375 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009376 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009377 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9378 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9379
9380 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9381 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9382 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9383 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9384 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9385 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9386 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9387 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9388 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9389 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009390
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009391 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9392 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009393 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9394 reference it.
9395
9396 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9397 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009398 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9399 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9400 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009401
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009402 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9403 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9404 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9405 something that can be ignored.
9406
9407 Example:
9408 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9409 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9410 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9411 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9412
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009413 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009414 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009415
9416
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009417stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009418 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9420 no | no | yes | yes
9421
9422 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009423 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009424 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009425 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009426 server is selected.
9427
9428 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9429 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9430 the "stick-table" statement.
9431
9432 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9433 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9434 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9435 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9436
9437 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9438 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9439 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9440 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9441 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9442 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009443 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009444 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9445 rules.
9446
9447 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9448 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9449 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9450 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9451 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9452 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9453 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9454
9455 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9456 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9457 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9458 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9459
9460 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9461 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9462 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9463 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9464 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9465 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009466 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9467 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9468 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9469 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9470 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9471 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9472 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9473 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9474 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009475
9476 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9477
9478 Example :
9479 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9480 backend https
9481 mode tcp
9482 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009483 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009484 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009485
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009486 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9487 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9488
9489 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9490 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9491 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9492
9493 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9494 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009495
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009496 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9497 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9498 # at offset 44.
9499
9500 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9501 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9502
9503 # Learn on response if server hello.
9504 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009505
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009506 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9507 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9508
9509 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9510 extraction.
9511
9512
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009513tcp-check connect [params*]
9514 Opens a new connection
9515 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9516 no | no | yes | yes
9517
9518 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9519 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9520 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9521
9522 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9523 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9524 of the sequence.
9525
9526 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9527 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9528 do.
9529
9530 Parameters :
9531 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9532 use the TCP connection.
9533
9534 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9535 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9536 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9537
9538 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9539
9540 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9541
9542 Examples:
9543 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9544 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9545 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9546 option tcp-check
9547 tcp-check connect
9548 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9549 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9550 tcp-check send \r\n
9551 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9552 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9553 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9554 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9555 tcp-check send \r\n
9556 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9557 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9558
9559 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9560 option tcp-check
9561 tcp-check connect port 110
9562 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9563 tcp-check connect port 143
9564 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9565 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9566
9567 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9568
9569
9570tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009571 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9573 no | no | yes | yes
9574
9575 Arguments :
9576 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9577 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9578 binary.
9579 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9580 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9581 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9582
9583 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9584 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9585 with the usual backslash ('\').
9586 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009587 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009588 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9589 used upper or lower case.
9590
9591
9592 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9593
9594 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9595 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9596 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9597 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9598 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9599 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9600 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9601 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9602
9603 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9604 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9605 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9606 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9607 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9608 expression.
9609
9610 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9611 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9612 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9613 this exact hexadecimal string.
9614 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9615
9616 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9617 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9618 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9619 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9620 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9621 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9622 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9623 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9624 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9625 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9626 the null character.
9627
9628 Examples :
9629 # perform a POP check
9630 option tcp-check
9631 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9632
9633 # perform an IMAP check
9634 option tcp-check
9635 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9636
9637 # look for the redis master server
9638 option tcp-check
9639 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009640 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009641 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9642 tcp-check expect string role:master
9643 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9644 tcp-check expect string +OK
9645
9646
9647 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9648 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9649
9650
9651tcp-check send <data>
9652 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9654 no | no | yes | yes
9655
9656 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9657 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9658
9659 Examples :
9660 # look for the redis master server
9661 option tcp-check
9662 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9663 tcp-check expect string role:master
9664
9665 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9666 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9667
9668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009669tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9670 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009671 tcp health check
9672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 no | no | yes | yes
9674
9675 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9676 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009678 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9679 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9680 hexadecimal string.
9681 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9682
9683 Examples :
9684 # redis check in binary
9685 option tcp-check
9686 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9687 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9688
9689
9690 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9691 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9692
9693
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009694tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9695 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9697 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009698 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009699 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9700 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009701
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009702 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009703
9704 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9705 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009706 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9707 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9708 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9709 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9710 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9711 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009712
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009713 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9714 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9715 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9716 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009717
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009718 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009719 - accept :
9720 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9721 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9722 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009724 - reject :
9725 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9726 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9727 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9728 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9729 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9730 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9731 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9732 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9733 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9734 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9735 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009736 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009737
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009738 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9739 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9740 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9741 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9742 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9743 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9744 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9745 hosts.
9746
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009747 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9748 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9749 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9750 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9751 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9752 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9753 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9754 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9755
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009756 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9757 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9758 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9759 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9760 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9761 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9762 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9763 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9764 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009765 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9766 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009767
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009768 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009769 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009770 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9771 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9772 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9773 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9774 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9775 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9776 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9777 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9778 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9779 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9780 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9781 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009782
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009783 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009784 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009785 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009786 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009787 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9788 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9789 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009790
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009791 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9792 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9793 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9794 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009795
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009796 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9797 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9798 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9799 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9800 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009801 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9802 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9803 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9804 layer7 information is extracted.
9805
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009806 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9807 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9808 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9809 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9810 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009811
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009812 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9813 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9814 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9815 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9816
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009817 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9818 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9819 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9820 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9821
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009822 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9823 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9824 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9825 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9826 continues.
9827
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009828 - set-src <expr> :
9829 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9830 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9831 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009832 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009834 Arguments:
9835 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9836 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009837
9838 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009839 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9840
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009841 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9842 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009843
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009844 - set-src-port <expr> :
9845 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9846 expression.
9847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009848 Arguments:
9849 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9850 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009851
9852 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009853 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9854
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009855 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9856 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9857 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009858
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009859 - set-dst <expr> :
9860 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9861 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9862 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9863 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9864 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9865
9866 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9867 followed by some converters.
9868
9869 Example:
9870
9871 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9872 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9873
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009874 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9875 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9876
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009877 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9878 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9879 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9880 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9881
9882
9883 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9884 followed by some converters.
9885
9886 Example:
9887
9888 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9889
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009890 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9891 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9892 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9893
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009894 - "silent-drop" :
9895 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009896 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009897 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9898 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9899 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9900 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9901 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009902 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9903 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009904 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9905 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009906 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009907 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9908 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9909 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9910 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9911
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009912 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9913 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9914 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009916 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9917 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9918 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009919
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009920 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009921 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009922 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009924 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9925 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9926 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009927
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009928 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009929 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9930 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009931
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009932 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9933
9934 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9935
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009936 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9937
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009938 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009939
9940
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009941tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9942 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009944 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009945 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009946 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9947 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009948
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009949 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009950
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009951 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009952 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9953 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9954 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9955 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009957 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9958 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9959 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9960 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009961 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9962 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9963 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9964 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9965 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9966 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009967 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009968 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009969
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009970 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9971 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9972 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9973 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009974
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009975 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009976 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009977 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009978 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9979 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009980 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009981 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009982 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009983 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009984 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009985 - set-dst <expr>
9986 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009987 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009988 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009989 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009990 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009991
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009992 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9993 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009994 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9995 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009996
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009997 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9998 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9999 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10000 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10001 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10002 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010004 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010005 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10006 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010008 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010009 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10010 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10011 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10012 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010013 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10014 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10015 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010016
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010017 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010018 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10019 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10020 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010021
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010022 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10023 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10024
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010025 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010026 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10027 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010028
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010029 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10030 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010031 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010032 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10033 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010034 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010035 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010036 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010037 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10038 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010039 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010040 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10041 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010042
10043 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10044 followed by some converters.
10045
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010046 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10047 <var-name>.
10048
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010049 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10050 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10051 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10052 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10053 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10054
10055 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10056 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10057 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10058 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10059 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10060 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10061 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10062 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10063 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10064 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10065 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10066
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010067 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10068 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10069 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10070 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10071 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10072
10073 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10074
10075 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10076
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010077 Example:
10078
10079 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010080 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010081
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010082 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010083 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10084 # and reject everything else.
10085 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10086 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010087 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010088 tcp-request content reject
10089
10090 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010091 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10092 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10093 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010094 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010095
10096 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10097 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10098 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010099 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010100 tcp-request content reject
10101
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010102 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010103 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010104 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010105 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010106 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10107 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010108
10109 Example:
10110 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10111 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010112 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010114 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010115 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010116
10117 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010118 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010119 # protecting all our sites
10120 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010121 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10122 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010123 ...
10124 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10125
10126 backend http_dynamic
10127 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010128 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010129 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010130 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010131 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010132 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010133 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010135 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010136
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010137 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10138 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010139
10140
10141tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10142 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010144 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010145 Arguments :
10146 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10147 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10148 as explained at the top of this document.
10149
10150 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10151 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10152 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10153 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10154 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10155
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010156 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10157 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10158 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10159 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10160
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010161 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10162 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010163 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010164 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010165 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10166 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10167 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10168 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010169
10170 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10171 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10172 it pass through unaffected.
10173
10174 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10175 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10176 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010177 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010178 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10179 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010180 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10181 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10182 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010184 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010185 "timeout client".
10186
10187
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010188tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10189 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10191 no | no | yes | yes
10192 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010193 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10194 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010195
10196 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10197
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010198 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010199 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10200 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010201 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10202 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010203
10204 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10205
10206 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10207 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10208 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10209 inserted.
10210
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010211 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010212 - accept :
10213 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10214 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10215 the rules evaluation.
10216
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010217 - close :
10218 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10219 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10220 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10221 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10222 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10223 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010224 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010225 protocols.
10226
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010227 - reject :
10228 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10229 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010230 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010231
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010232 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10233 Sets a variable.
10234
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010235 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10236 Unsets a variable.
10237
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010238 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10239 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10240 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10241 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10242
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010243 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10244 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10245 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10246 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10247
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010248 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10249 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10250 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10251 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10252 continues.
10253
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010254 - "silent-drop" :
10255 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010256 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010257 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10258 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10259 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10260 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10261 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010262 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10263 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010264 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10265 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010266 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010267 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10268 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10269 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10270 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10271
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010272 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10273 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10274
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010275 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10276 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10277 for changing the default action to a reject.
10278
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010279 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10280 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10281 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10282 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010283 period.
10284
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010285 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10286 declared inline.
10287
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010288 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10289 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010290 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010291 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10292 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010293 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010294 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010295 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010296 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10297 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010298 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010299 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10300 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010301
10302 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10303 followed by some converters.
10304
10305 Example:
10306
10307 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10308
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010309 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10310 <var-name>.
10311
10312 Example:
10313
10314 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10315
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010316 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10317 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10318 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10319 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10320 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10321
10322 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10323
10324 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10325
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010326 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10327
10328 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10329
10330
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010331tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10332 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10334 no | yes | yes | no
10335 Arguments :
10336 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10337 below.
10338
10339 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10340
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010341 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010342 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10343 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10344 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10345 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10346 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10347 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10348 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010349 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010350 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10351 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10352 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10353 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10354 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10355 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10356 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10357 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10358 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10359 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10360 instead.
10361
10362 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10363 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10364 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10365 rules which may be inserted.
10366
10367 Several types of actions are supported :
10368 - accept : the request is accepted
10369 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10370 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10371 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010372 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010373 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10374 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010375 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010376 - silent-drop
10377
10378 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10379 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10380 sections for a complete description.
10381
10382 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10383 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10384 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10385
10386 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10387 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10388 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10389 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10390 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10391
10392 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10393 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10394
10395 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10396 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10397 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10398
10399 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10400 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10401 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10402
10403 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10404 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10405 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10406
10407 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10408 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10409 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10410
10411 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10412
10413 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10414
10415
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010416tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10417 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10419 no | no | yes | yes
10420 Arguments :
10421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10423 as explained at the top of this document.
10424
10425 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10426
10427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010428timeout check <timeout>
10429 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10430 established.
10431
10432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10433 yes | no | yes | yes
10434 Arguments:
10435 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10436 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10437 as explained at the top of this document.
10438
10439 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10440 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010441 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010442 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010443 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10444 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10445 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010446
10447 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10448 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10449
10450 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10451 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010452 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010453
10454 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10455 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10456 forget about it.
10457
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010458 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10459 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010460
10461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010462timeout client <timeout>
10463timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10464 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10466 yes | yes | yes | no
10467 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010468 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010469 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10470 as explained at the top of this document.
10471
10472 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10473 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10474 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010475 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10476 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10477 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10478 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010479 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10480 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10481 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010482 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010483 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010484 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10485 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010486 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10487 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010488
10489 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10490 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10491 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10492 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10493 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10494 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10495
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010496 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010498 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10499 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10500 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10501
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010502 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10503 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010504
10505
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010506timeout client-fin <timeout>
10507 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10509 yes | yes | yes | no
10510 Arguments :
10511 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10512 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10513 as explained at the top of this document.
10514
10515 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10516 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10517 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10518 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10519 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10520 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10521 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010522 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10523 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10524 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010525
10526 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10527 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10528 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10529
10530 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10531
10532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010533timeout connect <timeout>
10534timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10535 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10537 yes | no | yes | yes
10538 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010539 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010540 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10541 as explained at the top of this document.
10542
10543 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010544 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010545 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010546 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010547 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10548 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010549
10550 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10551 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10552 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10553 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10554 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10555 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10556
10557 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10558 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10559 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10560
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010561 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10562 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010563
10564
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010565timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10566 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10568 yes | yes | yes | yes
10569 Arguments :
10570 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10571 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10572 as explained at the top of this document.
10573
10574 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10575 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10576 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10577 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10578 once the request has started to present itself.
10579
10580 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10581 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10582 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10583 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10584 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10585
10586 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10587 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10588 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10589 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10590
10591 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10592 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010594 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10595 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010596 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010597
10598 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10599 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10600 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10601 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10602
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010603 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10604 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010605 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10606
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010607 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10608
10609
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010610timeout http-request <timeout>
10611 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010613 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010614 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010615 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010616 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10617 as explained at the top of this document.
10618
10619 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10620 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10621 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10622 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10623 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10624 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10625 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010626 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10627 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10628 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10629 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010630 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010631 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10632 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010633
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010634 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10635 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10636 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10637 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10638 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010639 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010640
10641 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10642 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010643 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010644 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10645 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10646
10647 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010648 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10649 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10650 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010651
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010652 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010653 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010654
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010655
10656timeout queue <timeout>
10657 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10659 yes | no | yes | yes
10660 Arguments :
10661 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10662 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10663 as explained at the top of this document.
10664
10665 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10666 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10667 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10668 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10669 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10670
10671 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10672 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10673 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10674 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10675
10676 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10677
10678
10679timeout server <timeout>
10680timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10681 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10683 yes | no | yes | yes
10684 Arguments :
10685 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10686 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10687 as explained at the top of this document.
10688
10689 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10690 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10691 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10692 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10693 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10694 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10695 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10696
10697 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10698 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10699 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10700 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10701 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010702 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010703 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010704 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10705 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010706 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10707 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010708
10709 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10710 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10711 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10712 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10713 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10714 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10715
10716 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10717 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10718 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10719
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010720 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010721
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010722
10723timeout server-fin <timeout>
10724 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10726 yes | no | yes | yes
10727 Arguments :
10728 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10729 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10730 as explained at the top of this document.
10731
10732 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10733 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10734 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10735 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10736 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10737 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10738 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10739 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10740 situations, it should not be needed.
10741
10742 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10743 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10744 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10745
10746 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10747
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010748
10749timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010750 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10752 yes | yes | yes | yes
10753 Arguments :
10754 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10756 as explained at the top of this document.
10757
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010758 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10759 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10760 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10761 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010762
10763 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10764 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10765 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10766 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010767 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010768
10769 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10770
10771
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010772timeout tunnel <timeout>
10773 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10775 yes | no | yes | yes
10776 Arguments :
10777 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10778 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10779 as explained at the top of this document.
10780
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010781 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010782 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10783 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10784 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10786 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010787 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10788 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10789 specified.
10790
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010791 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10792 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10793 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10794 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10795 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10796 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10797 state.
10798
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010799 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10800 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10801 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10802 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010803 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010804
10805 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10806 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10807 forget about it.
10808
10809 Example :
10810 defaults http
10811 option http-server-close
10812 timeout connect 5s
10813 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010814 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010815 timeout server 30s
10816 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10817
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010818 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010819
10820
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010821transparent (deprecated)
10822 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010824 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010825 Arguments : none
10826
10827 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10828 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10829 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10830 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10831 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10832 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10833 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10834 appropriate server.
10835
10836 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10837
10838 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10839 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10840
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010841 See also: "option transparent"
10842
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010843unique-id-format <string>
10844 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10846 yes | yes | yes | no
10847 Arguments :
10848 <string> is a log-format string.
10849
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010850 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10851 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10852 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10853 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010854
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010855 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10856 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10857 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10858 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10859 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10860 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10861 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10862 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010863
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010864 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10865 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010867 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010868
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010869 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010870
10871 will generate:
10872
10873 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10874
10875 See also: "unique-id-header"
10876
10877unique-id-header <name>
10878 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10880 yes | yes | yes | no
10881 Arguments :
10882 <name> is the name of the header.
10883
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010884 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10885 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010886
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010887 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010888
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010889 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010890 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10891
10892 will generate:
10893
10894 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10895
10896 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010897
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010898use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010899 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10901 no | yes | yes | no
10902 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010903 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10904 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010905
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010906 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10907 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010908
10909 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10910 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10911 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010912 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010913 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010914 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10915 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010916
10917 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10918 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10919 assign the backend.
10920
10921 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10922 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10923 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10924 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10925 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10926 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10927
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010928 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010929 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010930 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10931 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10932 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10933
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010934 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10935 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10936 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10937 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10938 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10939 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10940 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10941 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10942 cannot be forced from the request.
10943
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010944 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010945 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10946 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10947
10948 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10949 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010950
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010951
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010952use-server <server> if <condition>
10953use-server <server> unless <condition>
10954 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10956 no | no | yes | yes
10957 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010958 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010959
10960 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10961
10962 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10963 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10964 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10965
10966 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10967 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10968 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10969 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10970 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10971 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10972 matches will assign the server.
10973
10974 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10975 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10976 with the next rules until one matches.
10977
10978 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10979 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10980 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10981 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10982
10983 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10984 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10985 stripped.
10986
10987 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10988 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10989 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10990 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10991
10992 Example :
10993 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10994 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10995 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10996 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10997 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10998 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010999 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011000 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11001 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11002
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011003 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011004
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011005
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100110065. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011007--------------------------
11008
11009The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11010depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11011settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11012written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11013described in this section.
11014
11015
110165.1. Bind options
11017-----------------
11018
11019The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11020as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11021no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11022parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11023while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11024provided immediately after the setting name.
11025
11026The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11027
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011028accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11029 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11030 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11031 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11032 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11033 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11034 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11035 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11036 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11037 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011038 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11039 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11040 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011041
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011042accept-proxy
11043 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011044 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11045 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011046 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11047 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11048 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11049 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011050 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011051 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11052 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011053 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11054 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011055
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011056allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011057 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011058 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
11059 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
11060 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11061 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011062
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011063alpn <protocols>
11064 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11065 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11066 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11067 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11068 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011069 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11070 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11071 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11072 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11073 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11074 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11075 preference, like below :
11076
11077 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011078
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011079backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011080 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011081 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11082
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011083curves <curves>
11084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11085 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11086 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11087 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11088 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11089 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11090
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011091ecdhe <named curve>
11092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011093 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11094 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011095
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011096ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011097 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11098 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11099 client's certificate.
11100
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011101ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11103 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11104 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11105 error is ignored.
11106
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011107ca-sign-file <cafile>
11108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11109 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11110 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11111 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11112 'generate-certificates' for details.
11113
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011114ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011115 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11116 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11117 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11118 'generate-certificates' for details.
11119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011120ciphers <ciphers>
11121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11122 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011123 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011124 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011125 information and recommendations see e.g.
11126 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11127 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11128 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11129
11130ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11132 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11133 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11134 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011135 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11136 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011137
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011138crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11140 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11141 to verify client's certificate.
11142
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011143crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11145 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11146 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11147 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11148 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11149 file.
11150
11151 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11152 are loaded.
11153
11154 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011155 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011156 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11157 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11158 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11159 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011160 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11161 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011162 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011163
11164 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11165 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11166 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11167 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011168 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11169 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011170
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011171 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011172
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011173 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011174 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011175 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11176 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011177 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11178 clients).
11179
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011180 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11181 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11182 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11183 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11184 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11185 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11186 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11187 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11188 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11189 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11190 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11191 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11192 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11193
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011194 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11195 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11196 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11197 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11198 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11199
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011200 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11201 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11202 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11203 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011204
11205 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11206 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11207 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11208 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11209 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11210 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11211 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11212 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11213 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11214
11215 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11216
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011217 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011218 a cert bundle.
11219
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011220 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011221 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11222 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11223 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11224 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11225 provide multi-cert support.
11226
11227 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11228
11229 Filename | CN | SAN
11230 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11231 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011232 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011233 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11234 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11235
11236 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11237 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11238 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11239 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011240 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11241 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11242 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011243
11244 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11245 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11246
11247 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11248 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11249 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11250
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011251crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011253 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011254 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011255 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011256
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011257crt-list <file>
11258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011259 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11260 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011261
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011262 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11263
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011264 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11265 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011266 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011267 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011268
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011269 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11270 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11271 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11272 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11273 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11274 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11275 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11276 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011277
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011278 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011279 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011280 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11281 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11282 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011283
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011284 crt-list file example:
11285 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011286 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011287 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011288 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011289
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011290defer-accept
11291 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11292 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11293 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011294 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011295 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11296 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11297 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11298 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11299 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11300 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11301 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11302
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011303expose-fd listeners
11304 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11305 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011306 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11307 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011308 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011309
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011310force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011311 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011312 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011313 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011314 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011315
11316force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011317 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011318 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011319 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011320
11321force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011322 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011323 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011324 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011325
11326force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011327 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011328 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011329 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011330
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011331force-tlsv13
11332 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11333 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011334 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011335
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011336generate-certificates
11337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11338 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11339 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11340 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11341 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11342 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11343 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11344 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11345 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11346 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11347 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11348
11349 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11350 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011351 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011352 certificate is used many times.
11353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011354gid <gid>
11355 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11356 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11357 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11358 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11359 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11360
11361group <group>
11362 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11363 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11364 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11365 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11366 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11367
11368id <id>
11369 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11370 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11371 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11372 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11373
11374interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011375 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11376 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11377 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11378 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11379 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11380 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011381 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11382 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11383 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11384 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11385 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11386 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011387
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011388level <level>
11389 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11390 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11391 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011392 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011393 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11394 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11395 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011396 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011397 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011398 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011399 all counters).
11400
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011401severity-output <format>
11402 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11403 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11404 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11405 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11406 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11407 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11408 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11409 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11410 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11411 rfc5424 convention.
11412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011413maxconn <maxconn>
11414 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11415 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11416 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11417 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11418 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11419 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11420 eat all memory.
11421
11422mode <mode>
11423 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11424 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11425 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11426 UNIX sockets.
11427
11428mss <maxseg>
11429 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11430 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11431 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11432 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11433 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11434 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11435 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11436 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11437 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11438 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11439 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11440
11441name <name>
11442 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11443 page.
11444
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011445namespace <name>
11446 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11447 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11448 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11449 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11450
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011451nice <nice>
11452 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11453 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11454 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11455 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11456 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11457 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11458 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11459 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11460 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11461 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11462 one for an RDP socket.
11463
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011464no-ca-names
11465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11466 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11467
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011468no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011470 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011471 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011472 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011473 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11474 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011475
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011476no-tls-tickets
11477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11478 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11479 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011480 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11481 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011482
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011483no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011485 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011486 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011487 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011488 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11489 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011490
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011491no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011493 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011494 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011495 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011496 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11497 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011498
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011499no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011501 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011502 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011503 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011504 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11505 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011506
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011507no-tlsv13
11508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11509 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11510 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11511 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011512 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11513 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011514
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011515npn <protocols>
11516 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11517 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11518 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11519 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011520 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011521 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11522 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11523 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11524 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11525 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011526
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011527prefer-client-ciphers
11528 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11529 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11530 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011531 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11532 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11533 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011534
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011535process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011536 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011537 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011538 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011539 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11540 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11541 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11542 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011543 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011544 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11545 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11546 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11547 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11548 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011549
11550 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11551
11552 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11553 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11554 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11555 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11556 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11557 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11558 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11559 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011560
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011561proto <name>
11562 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11563 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11564 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11565 in haproxy -vv.
11566 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11567 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011568 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011569 h2" on the bind line.
11570
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011571ssl
11572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011573 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011574 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11575 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011576 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11577 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011578
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011579ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11580 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11581 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11582 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11583
11584ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11585 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11586 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11587 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11588
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011589strict-sni
11590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11591 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11592 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11593 See the "crt" option for more information.
11594
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011595tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011596 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011597 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11598 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011599 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011600 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11601 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11602 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11603 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11604 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11605 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11606 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11607
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011608tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011609 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011610 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11611 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11612 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11613 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11614 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11615 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11616 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011617 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11618 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11619 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011620
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011621tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11622 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011623 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11624 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11625 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11626 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11627 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11628 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11629 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11630 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11631 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11632 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011633 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11634 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11635
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011636transparent
11637 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11638 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11639 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11640 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11641 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11642 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11643 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11644 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11645 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11646 so check for support with your vendor.
11647
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011648v4v6
11649 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11650 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11651 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11652 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011653 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011654
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011655v6only
11656 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11657 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11658 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011659 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11660 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011661
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011662uid <uid>
11663 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11664 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11665 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11666 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11667 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11668
11669user <user>
11670 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11671 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11672 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11673 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11674 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11675
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011676verify [none|optional|required]
11677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11678 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11679 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11680 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11681 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011682 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11683 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11684 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11685 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011686
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200116875.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011688------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011690The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11691which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11692arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11693settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11694after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11695Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11696address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011697
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011698 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011699 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011700
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011701Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11702keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011704The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011705
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011706addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011707 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011708 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11709 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11710 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11711 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11712 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011713
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011714agent-check
11715 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011716 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011717 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11718 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11719 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011720
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011721 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011722 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011723 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11724 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11725 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011726
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011727 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11728 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11729 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11730 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11731 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011733 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011734 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011735
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011736 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11737 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11738 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011739
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011740 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11741 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11742 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011743
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011744 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11745 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11746 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11747 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11748 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011749 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011750 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011751
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011752 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11753 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011754
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011755 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11756 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11757 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11758 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11759 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11760 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11761 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11762 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11763 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011764
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011765 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11766 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011767 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11768 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11769 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011770 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011771
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011772 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011773 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011774
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011775agent-send <string>
11776 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11777 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11778 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11779 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11780 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11781
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011782agent-inter <delay>
11783 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11784 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11785
11786 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11787 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11788 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11789 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11790 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11791 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11792 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11793 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11794 of backends use the same servers.
11795
11796 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11797
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011798agent-addr <addr>
11799 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11800
11801 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11802 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11803 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11804 hostname, it will be resolved.
11805
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011806agent-port <port>
11807 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11808
11809 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11810
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011811alpn <protocols>
11812 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11813 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11814 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11815 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11816 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11817 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11818 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11819 now obsolete NPN extension.
11820 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11821 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11822
11823 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011825backup
11826 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11827 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11828 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11829 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011830 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11831 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011832
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011833ca-file <cafile>
11834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11835 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11836 server's certificate.
11837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011838check
11839 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011840 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11841 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11842 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11843 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11844 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11845 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11846 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011847 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11848 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011849 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11850 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011851
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011852check-send-proxy
11853 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11854 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11855 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11856 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11857 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11858 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11859 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11860
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011861check-alpn <protocols>
11862 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11863 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11864 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11865
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011866check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011867 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011868 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11869 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011870
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011871check-ssl
11872 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11873 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11874 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11875 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011876 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011877 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11878 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011879 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011880 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11881 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011882
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011883ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11885 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11886 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011887 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11888 information and recommendations see e.g.
11889 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11890 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11891 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011892
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011893ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11895 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11896 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11897 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011898 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11899 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11900 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011902cookie <value>
11903 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11904 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11905 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11906 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11907 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11908 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11909 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11910
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011911crl-file <crlfile>
11912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11913 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11914 to verify server's certificate.
11915
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011916crt <cert>
11917 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11918 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11919 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11920 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11921 certificate request.
11922
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011923disabled
11924 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11925 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11926 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11927 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11928 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011929 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011930
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011931enabled
11932 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11933 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11934 default value.
11935 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11936 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011938error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011939 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11940 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11941 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011943 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011945fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011946 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11947 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11948 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11949
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011950force-sslv3
11951 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11952 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011953 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011954 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011955
11956force-tlsv10
11957 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011958 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011959 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011960
11961force-tlsv11
11962 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011963 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011964 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011965
11966force-tlsv12
11967 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011968 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011969 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011970
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011971force-tlsv13
11972 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11973 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011974 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011976id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011977 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11978 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11979 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011980
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011981init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11982 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11983 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011984 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011985 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11986 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11987 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11988 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11989 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11990 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11991 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11992 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11993 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011994 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011995 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11996 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11997 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11998 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11999 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12000 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012001 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012002
12003 Example:
12004 defaults
12005 # never fail on address resolution
12006 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012008inter <delay>
12009fastinter <delay>
12010downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012011 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12012 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12013 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12014 between checks depending on the server state :
12015
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012016 Server state | Interval used
12017 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12018 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12019 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12020 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12021 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12022 or yet unchecked. |
12023 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12024 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12025 | "inter" otherwise.
12026 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012028 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12029 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12030 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12031 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012032 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12033 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12034 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12035 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12036 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012038maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012039 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12040 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12041 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12042 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12043 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12044 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12045 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12046 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012048maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012049 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12050 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12051 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12052 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12053 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12054 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12055 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12056
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012057max-reuse <count>
12058 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12059 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12060 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12061 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12062 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12063 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12064 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12065 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012067minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012068 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12069 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12070 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12071 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12072 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12073 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012074 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012075 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012076
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012077namespace <name>
12078 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12079 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12080 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12081 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12082
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012083no-agent-check
12084 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12085 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12086 default value.
12087 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12088 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12089
12090no-backup
12091 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12092 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12093 default value.
12094 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12095 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12096
12097no-check
12098 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12099 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12100 default value.
12101 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12102 "default-server" "check" setting.
12103
12104no-check-ssl
12105 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12106 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12107 default value.
12108 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12109 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12110
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012111no-send-proxy
12112 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12113 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12114 default value.
12115 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12116 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12117
12118no-send-proxy-v2
12119 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12120 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12121 default value.
12122 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12123 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12124
12125no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12126 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12127 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12128 default value.
12129 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12130 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12131
12132no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12133 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12134 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12135 default value.
12136 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12137 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12138
12139no-ssl
12140 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12141 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12142 default value.
12143 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12144 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12145
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012146no-ssl-reuse
12147 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12148 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12149 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12150 and for paranoid users.
12151
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012152no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012153 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12154 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012155 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012156
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012157 Supported in default-server: No
12158
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012159no-tls-tickets
12160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12161 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12162 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012163 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12164 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012165 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012166
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012167no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012168 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012169 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12170 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012171 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12172 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012173 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012174
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012175 Supported in default-server: No
12176
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012177no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012178 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012179 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12180 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012181 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12182 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012183 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012184
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012185 Supported in default-server: No
12186
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012187no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012188 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012189 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12190 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012191 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12192 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012193 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012194
12195 Supported in default-server: No
12196
12197no-tlsv13
12198 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12199 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12200 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12201 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12202 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012203 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012204
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012205 Supported in default-server: No
12206
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012207no-verifyhost
12208 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12209 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12210 default value.
12211 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12212 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012213
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012214non-stick
12215 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12216 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12217 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12218
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012219npn <protocols>
12220 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12221 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12222 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12223 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12224 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12225 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12226 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012228observe <mode>
12229 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12230 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12231 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12232 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12233 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12234 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012235 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012236
12237 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012239on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012240 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12241 Currently, four modes are available:
12242 - fastinter: force fastinter
12243 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12244 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12245 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12246 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12247
12248 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12249
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012250on-marked-down <action>
12251 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12252 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012253 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12254 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12255 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12256 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12257 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12258 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12259 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12260 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012261
12262 Actions are disabled by default
12263
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012264on-marked-up <action>
12265 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12266 Currently one action is available:
12267 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12268 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12269 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12270 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012271 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12272 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012273 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12274 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12275
12276 Actions are disabled by default
12277
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012278pool-max-conn <max>
12279 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12280 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12281 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12282 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12283 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12284 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12285
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012286pool-purge-delay <delay>
12287 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012288 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12289 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012291port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012292 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12293 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12294 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12295 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12296 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12297 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12298
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012299proto <name>
12300
12301 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12302 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12303 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12304 reported in haproxy -vv.
12305 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12306 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012308redir <prefix>
12309 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12310 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12311 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12312 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12313 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12314 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12315 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12316 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012317 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012318 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012319 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12320 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12321 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12322 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12323
12324 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012326rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012327 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12328 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12329 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12330
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012331resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12332 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12333 server.
12334
12335 Available options:
12336
12337 * allow-dup-ip
12338 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12339 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12340 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12341 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12342 For such case, simply enable this option.
12343 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12344
12345 * prevent-dup-ip
12346 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12347 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12348 same fqdn.
12349 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12350
12351 Example:
12352 backend b_myapp
12353 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12354 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12355 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12356
12357 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12358 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12359 it
12360 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12361 different address
12362
12363 Default value: not set
12364
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012365resolve-prefer <family>
12366 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12367 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12368 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12369 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12370
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012371 Default value: ipv6
12372
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012373 Example:
12374
12375 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012376
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012377resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12378 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12379 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012380 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012381 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12382 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012383 configured network, another address is selected.
12384
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012385 Example:
12386
12387 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012388
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012389resolvers <id>
12390 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12391 hostname.
12392
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012393 Example:
12394
12395 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012396
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012397 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012398
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012399send-proxy
12400 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12401 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12402 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12403 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012404 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12405 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12406 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12407 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12408 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12409 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12410 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12411 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12412 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12413 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012414 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12415 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012416
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012417send-proxy-v2
12418 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12419 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12420 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12421 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012422 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12423 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12424 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12425 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012426
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012427proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12428 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12429 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012430 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12431 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012432 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12433 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012434 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012435
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012436send-proxy-v2-ssl
12437 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12438 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12439 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12440 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12441 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12442 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12443 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012444 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12445 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012446
12447send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12448 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12449 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12450 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12451 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12452 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12453 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12454 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12455 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012456 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12457 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012459slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012460 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12461 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12462 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12463 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12464 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12465 parameters :
12466
12467 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12468 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12469
12470 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12471 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12472 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12473 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12474
12475 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12476 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12477 seen as failed.
12478
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012479sni <expression>
12480 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12481 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12482 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12483 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012484 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12485 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012486 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012487 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12488 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012489
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012490source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012491source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012492source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012493 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12494 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12495 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12496 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12497
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012498 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12499 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12500 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12501 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12502 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12503 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12504 server.
12505
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012506 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12507 specifying the source address without port(s).
12508
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012509ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012510 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12511 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12512 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12513 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12514 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12515 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012516 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12517 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012518
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012519ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12520 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12521 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12522 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12523
12524ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12525 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12526 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12527 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12528
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012529ssl-reuse
12530 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12531 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12532 default value.
12533 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12534 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12535
12536stick
12537 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12538 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12539 default value.
12540 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12541 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012542
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012543tcp-ut <delay>
12544 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12545 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12546 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012547 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012548 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12549 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12550 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12551 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12552 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12553 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12554 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12555 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12556 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012558track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012559 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12560 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12561 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12562 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012563 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12564
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012565tls-tickets
12566 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12567 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12568 default value.
12569 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12570 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012571
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012572verify [none|required]
12573 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012574 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012575 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12576 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012577 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012578 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12579 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12580 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12581 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12582 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12583 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12584 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12585 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012586
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012587verifyhost <hostname>
12588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012589 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12590 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12591 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12592 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12593 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12594 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12595 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12596 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012598weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012599 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12600 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12601 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012602 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12603 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12604 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12605 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12606 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12607 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012608
12609
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126105.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12611-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012612
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012613HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12614using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12615configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012616This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12617can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12618workload.
12619This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12620resolution at run time.
12621Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12622carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12623
12624
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126255.3.1. Global overview
12626----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012627
12628As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12629different steps of the process life:
12630
12631 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12632 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12633 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12634
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012635 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12636 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012637
12638A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12639 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12640 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12641 resolution to know this new IP.
12642
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012643When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012644HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012645SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12646from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12647will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12648will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012649
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012650A few things important to notice:
12651 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12652 first valid response.
12653
12654 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12655 servers return an error.
12656
12657
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126585.3.2. The resolvers section
12659----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012660
12661This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012662HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12663contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012664
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012665When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12666uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12667is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12668answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12669
12670When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012671used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012672
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012673 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12674 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12675 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012676
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012677 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12678 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012679
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012680 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12681 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12682 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012683
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012684For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12685following scenarios are possible:
12686
12687 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12688 ignored
12689
12690 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12691 applied
12692
12693 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12694 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12695
12696 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12697 retries the query with a new type
12698
12699 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12700 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012701
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012702As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12703a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012704<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012705
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012706
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012707resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012708 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012709
12710A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12711
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012712accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012713 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012714 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012715 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12716 by RFC 6891)
12717
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012718 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12719
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012720nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12721 DNS server description:
12722 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12723 <ip> : IP address of the server
12724 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12725
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012726parse-resolv-conf
12727 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12728 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12729 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12730
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012731hold <status> <period>
12732 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12733 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012734 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012735 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012736 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12737 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12738 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12739
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012740 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012741
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012742resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012743 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12744 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12745 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12746
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012747resolve_retries <nb>
12748 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12749 giving up.
12750 Default value: 3
12751
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012752 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12753 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12754 type.
12755
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012756timeout <event> <time>
12757 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12758 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12759 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012760 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12761 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012762 Default value: 1s
12763 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012764 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012765 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012766 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12767 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12768
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012769 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012770
12771 resolvers mydns
12772 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12773 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012774 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012775 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012776 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012777 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012778 hold other 30s
12779 hold refused 30s
12780 hold nx 30s
12781 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012782 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012783 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012784
12785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127866. HTTP header manipulation
12787---------------------------
12788
12789In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12790response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12791request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12792which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012793against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012794
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012795If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12796to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12797but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12798HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12799stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12800because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12801a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12802still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012804This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12805in section 4.2 :
12806
12807 - reqadd <string>
12808 - reqallow <search>
12809 - reqiallow <search>
12810 - reqdel <search>
12811 - reqidel <search>
12812 - reqdeny <search>
12813 - reqideny <search>
12814 - reqpass <search>
12815 - reqipass <search>
12816 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12817 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12818 - reqtarpit <search>
12819 - reqitarpit <search>
12820 - rspadd <string>
12821 - rspdel <search>
12822 - rspidel <search>
12823 - rspdeny <search>
12824 - rspideny <search>
12825 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12826 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12827
12828With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12829is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12830parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12831prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12832Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12833
12834 \t for a tab
12835 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12836 \n for a new line (LF)
12837 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12838 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12839 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12840 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12841 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12842
12843The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12844portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12845above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12846regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
128479 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12848is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12849
12850The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12851after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12852
12853Notes related to these keywords :
12854---------------------------------
12855 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12856 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12857 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12858
12859 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12860 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12861 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12862
12863 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12864 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12865 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12866 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12867 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12868
12869 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12870 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12871 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12872 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12873 useless headers before adding new ones.
12874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012875 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012876 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12877
12878 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12879 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12880 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12881
12882 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12883 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012884 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012885
12886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200128877. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12888----------------------------------
12889
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012890HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12892The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12893these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12894but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12895data called patterns.
12896
12897
128987.1. ACL basics
12899---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012900
12901The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12902content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12903from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12904simple :
12905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012907 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12909 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012911The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12912adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012913
12914In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012917
12918This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12919Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12920and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012921an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12922conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12923as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12924are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012925
12926ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12927'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12928which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12929
12930There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12931performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12934specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12935this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012936methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12937ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012938
12939Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12940 - boolean
12941 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12942 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12943 - string
12944 - data block
12945
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012946Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12947converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12948would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12949The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12950which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12951
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012952Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12953keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12954fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12955which are summarized in the table below :
12956
12957 +---------------------+-----------------+
12958 | Sample or converter | Default |
12959 | output type | matching method |
12960 +---------------------+-----------------+
12961 | boolean | bool |
12962 +---------------------+-----------------+
12963 | integer | int |
12964 +---------------------+-----------------+
12965 | ip | ip |
12966 +---------------------+-----------------+
12967 | string | str |
12968 +---------------------+-----------------+
12969 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12970 +---------------------+-----------------+
12971
12972Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12973matching method, see below.
12974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012975The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12976 - boolean
12977 - integer or integer range
12978 - IP address / network
12979 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12980 - regular expression
12981 - hex block
12982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012983The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12984
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012985 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12986 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012988 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012989 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012990 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012991 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012993The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12994read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12995if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12996lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12997will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12998beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12999a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13000lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13001exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13002
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013003The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13004parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13005ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13006a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13007check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13008
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013009The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13010socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13011file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13014loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13015
13016 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13017
13018In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13019the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13020case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13021as well.
13022
13023The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13024sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13025do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13026methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13027is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013028obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013029followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13030default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13031that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13032string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13033
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013034The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13035By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13036string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13037resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13038server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
13039waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
13040flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13041function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013043There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13044sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13045be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013046
13047 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13048 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013049 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13050 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13051 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13052 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013053
13054 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13055 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013057
13058 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013060
13061 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013063
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013064 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013065 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13066
13067 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13068 binary or string samples.
13069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013070 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13071 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013073 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13074 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13075 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13078 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013080 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13081 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013083 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13084 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13087 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013088 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013090 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13091 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13092 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013093
13094For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13095request, it is possible to do :
13096
13097 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13098
13099In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13100buffer, one would use the following acl :
13101
13102 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13103
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013104On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13105possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13106
13107 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013109All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13110criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13111method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13112to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13113criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13114the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013117the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13118For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013120 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13121 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13122 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13123 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013124
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013125
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013126The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13127types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13128combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13129brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13130default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013132 +-------------------------------------------------+
13133 | Input sample type |
13134 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013135 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013136 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13137 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13138 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013139 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013140 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013141 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013142 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013143 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013145 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013146 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013147 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013149 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013150 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013151 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013153 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013154 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013155 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013157 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013158 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013159 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13161 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13162 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013163
13164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131657.1.1. Matching booleans
13166------------------------
13167
13168In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13169Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13170When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13171that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13172
13173Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13174return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13175"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131787.1.2. Matching integers
13179------------------------
13180
13181Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13182enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13183to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13184
13185Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13186matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13187lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013188
13189For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13190unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13191representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13192
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013193As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13194two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13195instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13196ranges and operators.
13197
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013198For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013199operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13200Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13201of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013203Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013204
13205 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13206 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13207 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13208 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13209 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013211For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013212
13213 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13214
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013215This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13216
13217 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13218
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132207.1.3. Matching strings
13221-----------------------
13222
13223String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13224different forms :
13225
13226 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013227 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013228
13229 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013230 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013231
13232 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13233 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13234
13235 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13236 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13237
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013238 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13240 matches.
13241
13242 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13243 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13244 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013245
13246String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13247exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13248characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13249string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13250to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013251before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013252
13253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132547.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13255---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013256
13257Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13258they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13259possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13260passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13261the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013262the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13263match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013264
13265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132667.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13267-------------------------------------
13268
13269It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13270not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13271a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13272to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13273digits may be used upper or lower case.
13274
13275Example :
13276 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13277 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13278
13279
132807.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13281---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013282
13283IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13284netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13285within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013286host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013287difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13288at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13289does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13290parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013291
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013292The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13293abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13294
13295 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13296 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13297 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13298 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13299 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13300 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13301 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13302 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13303
13304Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13305192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13306
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013307IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13308Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13309trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13310IPv6 patterns.
13311
13312HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13313following situations :
13314 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13315 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13316 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13317 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13318 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13319 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13320 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13321 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13322 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13323 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013325
133267.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13327----------------------------------
13328
13329Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13330combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13331
13332 - AND (implicit)
13333 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13334 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013336A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13341indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013343For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13344"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13345requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13346is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13347
13348 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013349 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13350 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13351 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352
13353To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13354and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13355
13356 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13357 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13358 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13359 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13363 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13364 use_backend www if host_www
13365
13366It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13367expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13368be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13369the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13370
13371 The following rule :
13372
13373 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013374 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375
13376 Can also be written that way :
13377
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013378 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013379
13380It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13381to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13382simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13383sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13384good use is the following :
13385
13386 With named ACLs :
13387
13388 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13389 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13390 monitor fail if site_dead
13391
13392 With anonymous ACLs :
13393
13394 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13395
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013396See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13397keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398
13399
134007.3. Fetching samples
13401---------------------
13402
13403Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13404against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13405sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13406ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13407of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13408available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13409
13410This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13411Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13412compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13413deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13414
13415The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13416matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13417method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13418indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13419
13420As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13421when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13422mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13423the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13424ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13425
13426Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13427multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13428when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013429incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13430are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013431is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13432all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13433
13434Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13435 - name
13436 - name(arg1)
13437 - name(arg1,arg2)
13438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013439
134407.3.1. Converters
13441-----------------
13442
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013443Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13444of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13445is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13446was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013447has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013448unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13449
13450These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13451sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13452the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013453support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013454
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013455A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13456support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13457supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13458(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13459bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013461The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013462
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001346351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13464 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13465 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13466 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13467 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13468 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13469
13470 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013471 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13472 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013473 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13474 frontend http-in
13475 bind *:8081
13476 default_backend servers
13477 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13478 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13479
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013480add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013481 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013482 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013483 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13484 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013485 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013486 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13487 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13488 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13489 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013490 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013491 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013492
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013493aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13494 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13495 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13496 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13497 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13498 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13499 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13500
13501 Example:
13502 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13503 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13504
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013505and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013506 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013507 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013508 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13509 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013510 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013511 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13512 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13513 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13514 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013515 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013516 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013517
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013518b64dec
13519 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13520 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13521
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013522base64
13523 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013524 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013525 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13526
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013527bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013528 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013529 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013530 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013531 presence of a flag).
13532
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013533bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13534 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13535 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013536 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013537
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013538concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13539 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13540 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13541 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13542 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13543 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13544 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13545 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13546 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13547 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13548 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13549 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13550 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13551 delimitors.
13552
13553 Example:
13554 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13555 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13556 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13557 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13558
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013559cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013560 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13561 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013562
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013563crc32([<avalanche>])
13564 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13565 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13566 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13567 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13568 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13569 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13570 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13571 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13572 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13573 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013574 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13575
13576crc32c([<avalanche>])
13577 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13578 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13579 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13580 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13581 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13582 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13583 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13584 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013585
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013586da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013587 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13588 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13589 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13590 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013591 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013592 configuration language.
13593
13594 Example:
13595 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013596 bind *:8881
13597 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013598 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013599
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013600debug
13601 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13602 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13603 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13604
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013605div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013606 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13607 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013608 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013609 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13610 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013611 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013612 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13613 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13614 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13615 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013616 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013617 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013618
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013619djb2([<avalanche>])
13620 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13621 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13622 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13623 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13624 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13625 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13626 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013627 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13628 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013629
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013630even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013631 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013632 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13633
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013634field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13635 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13636 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13637 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13638 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13639 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13640 fields.
13641
13642 Example :
13643 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13644 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13645 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13646 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13647 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013648
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013649hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013650 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013651 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013653 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013654
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013655hex2i
13656 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13657 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13658
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013659http_date([<offset>])
13660 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13661 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13662 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13663 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13664 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13665 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013666
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013667in_table(<table>)
13668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13670 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013671 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013672 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13673
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013674ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13675 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013676 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013677 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13678 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13679 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13680 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13681 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013682
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013683json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013684 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013685 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013686 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013687 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13688 of errors:
13689 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13690 bytes, ...)
13691 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13692 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13693
13694 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13695 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13696 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13697 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13698 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13699 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013700 - "ascii" : never fails;
13701 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13702 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013703 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013704 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013705 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13706 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13707
13708 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013709 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013710
13711 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013712 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013713 capture request header user-agent len 150
13714 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013715
13716 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13717 GET / HTTP/1.0
13718 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13719
13720 Output log:
13721 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13722
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013723language(<value>[,<default>])
13724 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13725 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13726 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13727 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13728 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13729 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13730 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13731 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13732 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013733 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013734 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13735 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013736
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013737 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013738
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013739 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13740 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013741
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013742 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13743 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13744 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13745 use_backend spanish if es
13746 use_backend french if fr
13747 use_backend english if en
13748 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013749
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013750length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013751 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13752 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13753 type. The result is of type integer.
13754
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013755lower
13756 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13757 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13758 type. The result is of type string.
13759
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013760ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13761 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13762 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13763 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13764 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13765 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13766 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13767
13768 Example :
13769
13770 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013771 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013772 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13773
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013774map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13775map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13776map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13777 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13778 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13779 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13780 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13781 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13782 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13783 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13784 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013785
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013786 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13787 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13788 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013789
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013790 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013791 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013792
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013793 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13794 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13795 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13796 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013797 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13798 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013799 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13800 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13801 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13802 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13803 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13804 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13805 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13806 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013807 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13808 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13809 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013810 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13811 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13812 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13813 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13814 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013815
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013816 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13817 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13818 the corresponding match text.
13819
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013820 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13821 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13822 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13823 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13824 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013825
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013826 Example :
13827
13828 # this is a comment and is ignored
13829 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13830 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13831 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13832 | | | `---------- value
13833 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13834 | `---------------------------- key
13835 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13836
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013837mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013838 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13839 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013840 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013841 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013842 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013843 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13844 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13845 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13846 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013848 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013849
13850mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013851 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013852 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13853 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013854 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013855 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013856 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013857 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13858 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13859 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13860 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013861 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013862 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013863
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013864nbsrv
13865 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13866 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13867 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13868 map lookup.
13869
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013870neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013871 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13872 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13873 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13874 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013875
13876not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013877 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013878 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013879 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013880 absence of a flag).
13881
13882odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013883 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013884 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13885
13886or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013887 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013888 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013889 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13890 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013891 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013892 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13893 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13894 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13895 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013897 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013898
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013899protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13900 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13901 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13902 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13903 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13904 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13905 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13906 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13907 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13908 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13909 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13910 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13911
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013912regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013913 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13914 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13915 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13916 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13917 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13918 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13919 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13920 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13921 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13922 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013923 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13924 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13925 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13926 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013927
13928 Example :
13929
13930 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13931 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13932 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13933 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13934
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013935capture-req(<id>)
13936 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13937 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13938
13939 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013940 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13941 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013942
13943capture-res(<id>)
13944 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13945 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13946
13947 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013948 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13949 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013950
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013951sdbm([<avalanche>])
13952 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13953 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13954 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13955 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13956 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13957 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13958 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013959 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13960 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013961
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013962set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013963 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13964 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13965 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013966 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013967 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13968 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013969 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013970 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13971 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013973 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013974
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013975sha1
13976 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13977 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13978
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013979strcmp(<var>)
13980 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13981 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13982 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13983 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13984 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13985 shorter).
13986
13987 Example :
13988
13989 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13990 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13991 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13992
13993
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013994sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013995 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13996 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013997 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013998 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13999 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014000 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014001 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14002 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014003 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014004 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14005 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014007 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014008
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014009table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14010 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14011 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14012 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14013 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14014 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14015 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14016
14017
14018table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14022 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14023 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14024 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14025
14026table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014030 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14031 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14032
14033table_conn_cur(<table>)
14034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14037 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14038 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14039
14040table_conn_rate(<table>)
14041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14043 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14044 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14045 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14046
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014047table_gpt0(<table>)
14048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14050 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14051 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14052 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14053
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014054table_gpc0(<table>)
14055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14058 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14059 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14060
14061table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14065 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14066 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14067 sample fetch keyword.
14068
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014069table_gpc1(<table>)
14070 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14071 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14072 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14073 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14074 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14075
14076table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14080 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14081 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14082 sample fetch keyword.
14083
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014084table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14085 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14086 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014087 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014088 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14089 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14090
14091table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14094 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14095 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14096 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14097 keyword.
14098
14099table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14100 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14101 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014103 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14104 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14105
14106table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14109 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14110 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14111 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14112 keyword.
14113
14114table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14115 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14116 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014117 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014118 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14119 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14120 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14121 keyword.
14122
14123table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014127 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14128 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14129 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14130 keyword.
14131
14132table_server_id(<table>)
14133 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14134 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14135 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14136 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14137 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14138 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14139
14140table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14141 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14142 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014143 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014144 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14145 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14146 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14147 keyword.
14148
14149table_sess_rate(<table>)
14150 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14151 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14152 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14153 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14154 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14155 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14156 keyword.
14157
14158table_trackers(<table>)
14159 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14160 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14161 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14162 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14163 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14164 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14165 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14166 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14167 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14168 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14169
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014170upper
14171 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14172 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14173 type. The result is of type string.
14174
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014175url_dec
14176 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14177 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14178
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014179ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014180 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014181 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14182 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14183 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014184 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14185 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14186 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14187 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014188 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014189 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14190 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014191
14192 Example:
14193 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14194 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14195
14196 message Point {
14197 int32 latitude = 1;
14198 int32 longitude = 2;
14199 }
14200
14201 message PPoint {
14202 Point point = 59;
14203 }
14204
14205 message Rectangle {
14206 // One corner of the rectangle.
14207 PPoint lo = 48;
14208 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14209 PPoint hi = 49;
14210 }
14211
14212 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14213 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14214 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14215
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014216 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14217 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14218 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14219 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14220
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014221 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014222
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014223 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014224
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014225 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14226 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14227 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14228
14229 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14230 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14231 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14232
14233 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14234 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14235 interpret the previous binary sample.
14236
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014237
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014238unset-var(<var name>)
14239 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14240 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14241 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14242 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14243 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14244 response),
14245 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14246 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14247 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14248 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14249
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014250utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14251 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14252 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14253 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14254 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14255 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14256 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14257
14258 Example :
14259
14260 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014261 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014262 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14263
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014264word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14265 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14266 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14267 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14268 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14269 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14270
14271 Example :
14272 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14273 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14274 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14275 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14276 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014277
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014278wt6([<avalanche>])
14279 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14280 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14281 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14282 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14283 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14284 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14285 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014286 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14287 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014288
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014289xor(<value>)
14290 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014291 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014292 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014293 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014294 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014295 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14296 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014297 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14299 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014301 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014302
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014303xxh32([<seed>])
14304 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14305 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14306 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14307 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14308 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14309 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14310 as cryptographically secure.
14311
14312xxh64([<seed>])
14313 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14314 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14315 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14316 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14317 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14318 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14319 as cryptographically secure.
14320
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014321
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143227.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014323--------------------------------------------
14324
14325A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14326not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14327"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14328The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14329
14330always_false : boolean
14331 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14332 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14333
14334always_true : boolean
14335 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14336 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14337
14338avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014339 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014340 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14341 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14342 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14343 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14344 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14345 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14346 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14347 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14348 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14349 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14350 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14351 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14352 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014354be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014355 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14356 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14357 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14358 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014359 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14360
14361be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14362 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14363 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14364 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14365 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14366 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014367 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14368 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014369
14370 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14371 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14372 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014374be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14376 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14377 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014378 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014379 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14380 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014381
14382 Example :
14383 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14384 backend dynamic
14385 mode http
14386 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14387 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014388
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014389bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014390 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14391 of the string.
14392
14393bool(<bool>) : bool
14394 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14395 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014399 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14401 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014402
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014403 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014404 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014405 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14406
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014407 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14408 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014409
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014410 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014411 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014412 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014413 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014414 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014416 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014417
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014418 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14419 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014420 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014421 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014422
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014423cpu_calls : integer
14424 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14425 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14426 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14427 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14428 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14429 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14430
14431cpu_ns_avg : integer
14432 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14433 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14434 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14435 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14436 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14437 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14438 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14439 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14440 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14441 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14442 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14443
14444cpu_ns_tot : integer
14445 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14446 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14447 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14448 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14449 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14450 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14451 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14452 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14453 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14454 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14455 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14456 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14457 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14458
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014459date([<offset>]) : integer
14460 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14461 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14462 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14463 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014464 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14465
14466 Example :
14467
14468 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14469 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014470
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014471date_us : integer
14472 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14473 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14474 from the same timeval structure.
14475
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014476distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14477 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14478 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14479 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14480 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14481 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14482 list of supported tokens.
14483
14484distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14485 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14486 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14487 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14488 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14489 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14490 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14491 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14492 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14493 supported tokens.
14494
14495 Example :
14496 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14497 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14498 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14499 # send large files to the big farm
14500 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14501
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014502env(<name>) : string
14503 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14504 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14505 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14506 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14507 certain way.
14508
14509 Examples :
14510 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14511 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14512
14513 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14514 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14517 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014518 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14519 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14521 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014522 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014523 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14524 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014525
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014526fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14527 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14528 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14529 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014531fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14533 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14534 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14535 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14536 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14537 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14538 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14539 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014540
14541 Example :
14542 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14543 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14544 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14545 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14546 frontend mail
14547 bind :25
14548 mode tcp
14549 maxconn 100
14550 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14551 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14552 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14553 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014554
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014555hostname : string
14556 Returns the system hostname.
14557
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014558int(<integer>) : signed integer
14559 Returns a signed integer.
14560
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014561ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14562 Returns an ipv4.
14563
14564ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14565 Returns an ipv6.
14566
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014567lat_ns_avg : integer
14568 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14569 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14570 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14571 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14572 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14573 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14574 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14575 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14576 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14577 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14578 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14579 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14580 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14581 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14582
14583lat_ns_tot : integer
14584 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14585 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14586 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14587 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14588 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14589 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14590 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14591 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14592 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14593 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14594 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14595 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14596 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14597 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14598 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14599 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14600 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14601 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14602 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14603
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014604meth(<method>) : method
14605 Returns a method.
14606
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014607nbproc : integer
14608 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14609 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14610 and debugging purposes.
14611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014612nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14613 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14614 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14615 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014616 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14617 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14618 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014619
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014620prio_class : integer
14621 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14622 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14623 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14624
14625prio_offset : integer
14626 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14627 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14628 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14629 set-priority-offset".
14630
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014631proc : integer
14632 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14633 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14634 debugging purposes.
14635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014636queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014637 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14638 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14639 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014640 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14641 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14642 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14643 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14644 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14645
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014646rand([<range>]) : integer
14647 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14648 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14649 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14650 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14651 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14654 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14655 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14656 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14657 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14658 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014659 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14660 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14661
14662srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14663 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14664 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14665 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14666 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14667 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14668 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14669 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14670
14671 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14672 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014673
14674srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14675 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14676 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14677 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014678 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014679 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14680 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14681 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14682
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014683srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14684 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14685 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14686 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14687 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14688 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14689 fetch methods.
14690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014691srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14692 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14693 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014694 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014695 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14696 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014697 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014698 overloading servers).
14699
14700 Example :
14701 # Redirect to a separate back
14702 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14703 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14704 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14705
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014706stopping : boolean
14707 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14708 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14709 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14710
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014711str(<string>) : string
14712 Returns a string.
14713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14715 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14716 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14717
14718table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14719 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14720 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14721 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14722
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014723thread : integer
14724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14725 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14726 and debugging purposes.
14727
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014728var(<var-name>) : undefined
14729 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014730 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14731 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014732 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014733 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14734 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014735 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014736 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14737 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014738 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014739 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014740
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147417.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014742----------------------------------
14743
14744The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14745closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14746methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14747sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14748TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014749the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14750counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014751"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14752used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14753can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14754Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14755table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14756tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14757currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014759bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014760 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14761 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14762 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764be_id : integer
14765 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14766 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14767
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014768be_name : string
14769 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14770 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014772dst : ip
14773 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14774 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14775 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14776 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014777 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14778 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14779 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14780 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14781 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14782 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783
14784dst_conn : integer
14785 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14786 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14787 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14788 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14789 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14790 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14791 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14792 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014793
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014794dst_is_local : boolean
14795 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14796 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14797 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14798 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014799 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014800 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14801 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14802 it only once per connection.
14803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804dst_port : integer
14805 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14806 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14807 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14808 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14809 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14810 an HTTP header.
14811
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014812fc_http_major : integer
14813 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14814 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14815 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14816
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014817fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14818 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14819 header.
14820
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014821fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14822 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14823 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14824 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14825 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14826 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14827 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14828
14829fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14830 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14831 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14832 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14833 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14834 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14835 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14836
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014837fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14838 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14839 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14840 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14841 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14842
14843fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14844 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14845 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14846 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14847 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14848
14849fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14850 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14851 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14852 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14853 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14854
14855fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14856 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14857 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14858 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14859 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14860
14861fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14862 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14863 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14864 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14865 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14866
14867fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14868 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14869 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14870 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14871 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14872
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014873fe_defbe : string
14874 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14875 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877fe_id : integer
14878 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014879 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14881
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014882fe_name : string
14883 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14884 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14885 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14886
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014887sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014888sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14889sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14890sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014891 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14892 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14893 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14894
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014895sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014896sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14897sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14898sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014899 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14900 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14901 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14902
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014903sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014904sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14905sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14906sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014907 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14908 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014909 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14910 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14911 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014912
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014913 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014914 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14915 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014916 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14917 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14918 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014919 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14920 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14921
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014922sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14923sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14924sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14925sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14926 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14927 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14928 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14929 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14930 when a first ACL was verified.
14931
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014932sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014933sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14934sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14935sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014936 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014937 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14938
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014939sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014940sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14941sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14942sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014943 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14944 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14945 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14946
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014947sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014948sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14949sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14950sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014951 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14952 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14953 See also src_conn_rate.
14954
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014955sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014956sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14957sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14958sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014959 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014960 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014961
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014962sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14963sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14964sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14965sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14966 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14967 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14968
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014969sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14970sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14971sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14972sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14973 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14974 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14975
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014976sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014977sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14978sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14979sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014980 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14981 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14982 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014983 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14984 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14985 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014986
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014987sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14988sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14989sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14990sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14991 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14992 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14993 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14994 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14995 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14996 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14997
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014998sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014999sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15000sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15001sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015002 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015003 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15004 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15005
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015006sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015007sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15008sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15009sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015010 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15011 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15012 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15013 src_http_err_rate.
15014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015015sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015016sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15017sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15018sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015019 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015020 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15021 src_http_req_cnt.
15022
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015023sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015024sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15025sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15026sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015027 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15028 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15029 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15030 src_http_req_rate.
15031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015032sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015033sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15034sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15035sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015036 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015037 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15038 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15039 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15040 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015041
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015042 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015043 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15044 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015045 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015047sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15048sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15049sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15050sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15051 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15052 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15053 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15054 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15055 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15056
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015057sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015058sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15059sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15060sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015061 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15062 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15063 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015064
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015065sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015066sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15067sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15068sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015069 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15070 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15071 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015072
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015073sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015074sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15075sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15076sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015077 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015078 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15079 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15080 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015081 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015082 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15083
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015084sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015085sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15086sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15087sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015088 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15089 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15090 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15091 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15092 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015093 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015094
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015095sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015096sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15097sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15098sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015099 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15100 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15101 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15102
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015103sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015104sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15105sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15106sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015107 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15108 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015109 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015110 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15111 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15113 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15114 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116so_id : integer
15117 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15118 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15119 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015122 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15124 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15125 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015126 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15127 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15128 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015129 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15130 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15131 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15132 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15133 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15134 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15135 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015136
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015137 Example:
15138 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15139 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15142 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15143 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15144 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015145 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015147src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15148 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15149 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015150 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015151 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15154 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15155 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15156 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15157 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15158 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15159 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015160
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015161 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015162 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15163 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15164 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15165 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015166 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015167 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15168 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15169
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015170src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15171 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15172 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15173 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15174 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15175 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15176 was verified.
15177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015179 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015181 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015182 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015185 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015186 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15187 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015188 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015190src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15191 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15192 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15193 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015194 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015197 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015199 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015200 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015201
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015202src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15203 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15204 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15205 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15206 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15207
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015208src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15209 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15210 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15211 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15212 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015215 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015217 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15218 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015219 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15220 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15221 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015222
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015223src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15224 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15225 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15226 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15227 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15228 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15229 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15230 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015233 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015234 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015235 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015236 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15240 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15241 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15242 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15243 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015244 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015247 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15249 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015250 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015252src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15253 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15254 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15255 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015256 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015257 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15260 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15261 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15262 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015263 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15265 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015266
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015267 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015268 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015269 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015270 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015271
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015272src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15273 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15274 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15275 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15276 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15277 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15278 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15279
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015280src_is_local : boolean
15281 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15282 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15283 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15284 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015285 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015286 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15287 once per connection.
15288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015290 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15291 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15292 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15293 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15294 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015297 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15298 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15299 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15300 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15301 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015303src_port : integer
15304 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15305 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15306 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15307 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015310 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015311 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15312 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15313 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015314 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15317 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15318 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15319 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15320 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015321 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15324 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15325 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15326 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15327 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15328 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15329 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15330 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15331 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015332
15333 Example :
15334 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15335 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15336 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15337 listen ssh
15338 bind :22
15339 mode tcp
15340 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015341 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015342 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015343 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015345srv_id : integer
15346 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15347 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15348 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015349
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153507.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015351----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015353The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15354closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15355when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15356usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015357future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015358
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001535951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15360 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15361 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15362 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15363 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15364 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15365
15366 Example :
15367 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15368 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15369 # the request.
15370 frontend http-in
15371 bind *:8081
15372 default_backend servers
15373 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15374 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15375
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015376ssl_bc : boolean
15377 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15378 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15379 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15380
15381ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15382 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15383 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15384
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015385ssl_bc_alpn : string
15386 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15387 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15388 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15389 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15390 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15391 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15392 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15393 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15394 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15395
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015396ssl_bc_cipher : string
15397 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15398 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15399
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015400ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15401 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15402 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15403 session or a TLS ticket.
15404
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015405ssl_bc_npn : string
15406 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15407 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15408 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15409 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15410 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15411 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15412 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15413 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15414
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015415ssl_bc_protocol : string
15416 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15417 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15418
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015419ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015420 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015421 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15422 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015423
15424ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15425 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15426 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15427 if session was reused or not.
15428
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015429ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15430 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15431 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15432 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15433 BoringSSL.
15434
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015435ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15436 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15437 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15440 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15441 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15442 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15443 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15444 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15447 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15448 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15449 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15450 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015451
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015452ssl_c_der : binary
15453 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15454 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15455 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457ssl_c_err : integer
15458 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15459 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15460 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15461 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15462 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015464ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15465 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15466 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15467 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15468 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15469 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15470 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15471 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15472 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474ssl_c_key_alg : string
15475 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15476 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15477 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479ssl_c_notafter : string
15480 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15481 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15482 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484ssl_c_notbefore : string
15485 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15486 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15487 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15490 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15491 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15492 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15493 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15494 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15495 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15496 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15497 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499ssl_c_serial : binary
15500 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15501 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15502 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15505 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15506 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15507 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015508 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15509 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15510
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015511 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015512 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15515 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15516 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15517 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519ssl_c_used : boolean
15520 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15521 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523ssl_c_verify : integer
15524 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15525 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15526 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15527 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015529ssl_c_version : integer
15530 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15531 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015532
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015533ssl_f_der : binary
15534 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15535 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15536 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15539 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15540 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15541 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15542 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015543 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15545 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15546 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548ssl_f_key_alg : string
15549 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15550 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15551 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553ssl_f_notafter : string
15554 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15555 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15556 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558ssl_f_notbefore : string
15559 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15560 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15561 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15564 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15565 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15566 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15567 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15568 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15569 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15570 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15571 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573ssl_f_serial : binary
15574 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15575 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15576 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015577
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015578ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15579 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15580 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15581 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15584 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15585 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15586 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588ssl_f_version : integer
15589 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15590 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15591
15592ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015593 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15594 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15595 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597 Example :
15598 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15599 listen http-https
15600 bind :80
15601 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15602 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15603
15604ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15605 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15606 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15607
15608ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015609 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15611 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15612 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15613 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15614 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15615 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15616 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15617 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619ssl_fc_cipher : string
15620 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15621 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015622
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015623ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15624 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15625 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015626 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015627
15628ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15629 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15630 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015631 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015632
15633ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15634 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15635 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15636 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015637 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015638 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015639
15640ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15641 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15642 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015643 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015646 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15647 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015648 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15649 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15650 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15651 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015652
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015653ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15654 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15655 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15656 wait until the handshake happened.
15657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15659 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015660 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15661 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15662 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15663 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015664
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015665ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015666 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015667 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15668 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015671 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15673 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15674 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15675 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15676 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15677 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15678 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680ssl_fc_protocol : string
15681 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15682 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015683
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015684ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015685 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015686 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15687 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15690 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15691 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15692 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15693 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015694
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015695ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15696 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15697 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15698 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15699 BoringSSL.
15700
15701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702ssl_fc_sni : string
15703 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15704 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15705 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15706 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15707 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15708
15709 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15710 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15711 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015712 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15713 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15717 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15720 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15721 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015722
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015723
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157247.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15728sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15729only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15730For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15731be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15732can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15733sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15734for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15735content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015738 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15740 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15743 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015744 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015746
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015747req.hdrs : string
15748 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15749 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15750 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15751 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15752
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015753req.hdrs_bin : binary
15754 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15755 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15756 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15757 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15758 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15759 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15760
15761 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15762
15763 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15764 str: <int:length><bytes>
15765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015766req.len : integer
15767req_len : integer (deprecated)
15768 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15769 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15770 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15771 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15772 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15773 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15774 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15775 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015777req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15778 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015779 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15780 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15781 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15782 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015784 ACL alternatives :
15785 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015787req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15788 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15789 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15790 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15791 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015793 ACL alternatives :
15794 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798req.proto_http : boolean
15799req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15800 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15801 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15802 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15803 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15804 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15805 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15806 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 Example:
15809 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15810 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15811 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015812 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15815rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15816 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15817 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15818 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15819 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15820 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15821 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15822 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015824 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15825 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15826 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15827 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15828 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15829 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831 ACL derivatives :
15832 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834 Example :
15835 listen tse-farm
15836 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15837 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15838 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15839 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15840 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15841 persist rdp-cookie
15842 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15843 # This is only useful makes sense if
15844 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15845 stick-table type string size 204800
15846 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15847 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15848 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15851 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015853req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15854rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15855 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15856 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15857 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15858 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860 ACL derivatives :
15861 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015862
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015863req.ssl_alpn : string
15864 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15865 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15866 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15867 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15868 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15869 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015870 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015871
15872 Examples :
15873 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15874 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15875 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015876 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015877 default_backend bk_default
15878
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015879req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15880 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15881 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015882 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15883 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15884 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15885 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15886 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15889req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15890 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15891 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15892 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15893 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15894 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15895 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15896 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898req.ssl_sni : string
15899req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15900 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15901 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15902 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15903 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15904 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15905 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15906 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15907 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15908 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15909 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15910 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15911 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913 ACL derivatives :
15914 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015916 Examples :
15917 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15918 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15919 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15920 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15921 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015922
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015923req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15924 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15925 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15926 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15927 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15928 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15929 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15930 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15931 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15932 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934req.ssl_ver : integer
15935req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15936 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15937 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15938 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15939 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15940 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15941 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15942 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015943 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946 ACL derivatives :
15947 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015948
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015949res.len : integer
15950 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15951 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15952 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15953 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15954 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15955 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15956 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15957 content inspection.
15958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15960 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015961 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15962 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15963 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15964 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15967 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15968 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15969 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15970 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015973
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015974res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15975rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15976 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15977 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15978 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15979 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15980 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15981 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15982 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984wait_end : boolean
15985 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15986 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015987 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015988 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15989 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015990 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15992 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015994 Examples :
15995 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15996 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15997 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16000 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16001 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16002 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16003 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16004 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16005 tcp-request content reject
16006
16007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160087.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009--------------------------------------
16010
16011It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16012This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16013data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16014its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16015HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16016content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16017to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16018more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16019response are indexed.
16020
16021base : string
16022 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16023 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16024 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16025 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16026 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16027 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16028 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16029 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16030
16031 ACL derivatives :
16032 base : exact string match
16033 base_beg : prefix match
16034 base_dir : subdir match
16035 base_dom : domain match
16036 base_end : suffix match
16037 base_len : length match
16038 base_reg : regex match
16039 base_sub : substring match
16040
16041base32 : integer
16042 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16043 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16044 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016045 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16046 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16047 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016048
16049base32+src : binary
16050 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16051 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16052 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16053 per-URL counters.
16054
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016055capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16056 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16057 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16058 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16059
16060capture.req.method : string
16061 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16062 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16063 because it's allocated.
16064
16065capture.req.uri : string
16066 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16067 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16068 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16069 allocated.
16070
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016071capture.req.ver : string
16072 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16073 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16074 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16075
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016076capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16077 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16078 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16079 The first entry is an index of 0.
16080 See also: "capture response header"
16081
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016082capture.res.ver : string
16083 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16084 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16085 persistent flag.
16086
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016087req.body : binary
16088 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16089 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16090 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16091 the first chunk is analyzed.
16092
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016093req.body_param([<name>) : string
16094 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16095 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16096 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16097 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16098 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16099 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16100 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16101 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16102 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16103 given.
16104
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016105req.body_len : integer
16106 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16107 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16108 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16109 "option http-buffer-request".
16110
16111req.body_size : integer
16112 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16113 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16114 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16115 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16116 "option http-buffer-request".
16117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118req.cook([<name>]) : string
16119cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16120 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16121 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16122 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16123 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16124 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16125 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16126 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16127 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16128
16129 ACL derivatives :
16130 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16131 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16132 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16133 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16134 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16135 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16136 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16137 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16140cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16141 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16142 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16145cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16146 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16147 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16148 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16149 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016151cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16152 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16153 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16154 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16155 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016156 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016157 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16158 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16159 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16160 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16163 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16164 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16165 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16166 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016167 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16170 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16171 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16172 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16173 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16174 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16175 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16176 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16177 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16180 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16181 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16182 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16183 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16186 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16187 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16188 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16189 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16190 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16191 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16192 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16193 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016194 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016196 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016198 ACL derivatives :
16199 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16200 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16201 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16202 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16203 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16204 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16205 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16206 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16207
16208req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16209hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16210 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16211 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16212 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16213 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16214 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16215 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16216 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16217 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16218 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16219
16220req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16221hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16222 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16223 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16224 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16225 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16226 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016227 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016228 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16229 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16230
16231req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16232hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16233 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16234 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16235 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16236 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16237 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16238 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16239 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16240
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016241
16242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16244 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16245 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16246 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16247 basic auth is supported.
16248
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016249http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16250 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16251 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16252 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16253 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016254 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16255 basic auth is supported.
16256
16257 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016258 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16259 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16260 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16261 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016262
16263http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016264 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16265 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16267 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016269method : integer + string
16270 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16271 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16272 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16273 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16274 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16275 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16276 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 ACL derivatives :
16279 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281 Example :
16282 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16283 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16284 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286path : string
16287 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16288 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16289 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16290 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16291 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016292 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295 ACL derivatives :
16296 path : exact string match
16297 path_beg : prefix match
16298 path_dir : subdir match
16299 path_dom : domain match
16300 path_end : suffix match
16301 path_len : length match
16302 path_reg : regex match
16303 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016304
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016305query : string
16306 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16307 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16308 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16309 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016310 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016311 which stops before the question mark.
16312
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016313req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16314 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16315 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16316 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16317 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016319req.ver : string
16320req_ver : string (deprecated)
16321 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16322 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16323 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325 ACL derivatives :
16326 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016328res.comp : boolean
16329 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16330 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16331 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333res.comp_algo : string
16334 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16335 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16336 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016338res.cook([<name>]) : string
16339scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16340 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16341 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16342 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344 ACL derivatives :
16345 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016347res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16348scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16349 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16350 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16351 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016353res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16354scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16355 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16356 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16357 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16360 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16361 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16362 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16363 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16364 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16365 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16366 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16367 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16368 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16371 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16372 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16373 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16374 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16375 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016377res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16378shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16379 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16380 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16381 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16382 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16383 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16384 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16385 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16386 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388 ACL derivatives :
16389 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16390 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16391 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16392 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16393 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16394 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16395 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16396 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16397
16398res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16399shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16400 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16401 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16402 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16403 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16404 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016406res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16407shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16408 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16409 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16410 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16411 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16412 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16413 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016414
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016415res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16416 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16417 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16418 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16419 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16422shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16423 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16424 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16425 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16426 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16427 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16428 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016430res.ver : string
16431resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16432 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16433 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435 ACL derivatives :
16436 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16439 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16440 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016441 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016444 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16445 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016447status : integer
16448 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16449 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16450 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016451
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016452unique-id : string
16453 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16454 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16455 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16456 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16457 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16458 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016460url : string
16461 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16462 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16463 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16464 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16465 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16466 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16467 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016469 ACL derivatives :
16470 url : exact string match
16471 url_beg : prefix match
16472 url_dir : subdir match
16473 url_dom : domain match
16474 url_end : suffix match
16475 url_len : length match
16476 url_reg : regex match
16477 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479url_ip : ip
16480 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16481 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16482 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16483 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16484 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16485 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16486 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016488url_port : integer
16489 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16490 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16491 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16492 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016493
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016494urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16495url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16497 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016498 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16499 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16500 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16501 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16503 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016504 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16505 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016507 ACL derivatives :
16508 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16509 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16510 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16511 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16512 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16513 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16514 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16515 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016516
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016518 Example :
16519 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16520 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16521 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16522 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016523
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016524urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16526 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16527 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016528
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016529url32 : integer
16530 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16531 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16532 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16533 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16534 is an unsigned integer.
16535
16536url32+src : binary
16537 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16538 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16539 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16540
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165427.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016543---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016545Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16546every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016547order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016549ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16550---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016551FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016552HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016553HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16554HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016555HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16556HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16557HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16558HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16559LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016560METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016561METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016562METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16563METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16564METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16565METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016566METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016567METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016568RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016569REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016570TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016571WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16572---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016573
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165758. Logging
16576----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16579provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16580very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16581provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16582state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016583to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584headers.
16585
16586In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16587about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16588send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16589
16590 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16591 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16592 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16593 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16594 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016595 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016596 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016597
16598The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16599allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16600as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16601while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16602real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16603delay.
16604
16605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166068.1. Log levels
16607---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016608
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016609TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016610source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016611HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16612in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16613track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16614syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16615about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016616
16617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166188.2. Log formats
16619----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016620
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016621HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016622and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16623slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16624options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016625
16626 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16627 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16628 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16629 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16630 extents.
16631
16632 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16633 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16634 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16635 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16636 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16637
16638 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16639 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16640 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16641 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16642 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16643
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016644 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16645 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16646 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16647 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16648
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016649 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16650
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016651Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16652specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16653field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16654servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16655always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16656identifier.
16657
16658Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16659 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16660 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16661 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16662 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16663
16664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166658.2.1. Default log format
16666-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016667
16668This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16669as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16670format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16671
16672 Example :
16673 listen www
16674 mode http
16675 log global
16676 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16677
16678 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16679 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16680 (www/HTTP)
16681
16682 Field Format Extract from the example above
16683 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16684 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16685 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16686 4 'to' to
16687 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16688 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16689
16690Detailed fields description :
16691 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16692 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16693 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16694 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16695 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16696 and processed the connection.
16697 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16698
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016699In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16700"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16701connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16702
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016703It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16704will eventually disappear.
16705
16706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167078.2.2. TCP log format
16708---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016709
16710The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16711is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16712information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16713counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16714emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16715environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16716the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16717sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016718specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16719not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16720fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16721marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016722
16723 Example :
16724 frontend fnt
16725 mode tcp
16726 option tcplog
16727 log global
16728 default_backend bck
16729
16730 backend bck
16731 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16732
16733 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16734 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16735 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16736
16737 Field Format Extract from the example above
16738 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16739 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16740 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16741 4 frontend_name fnt
16742 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16743 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16744 7 bytes_read* 212
16745 8 termination_state --
16746 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16747 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16748
16749Detailed fields description :
16750 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016751 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16752 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16753 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016754 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016755 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016756 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016757
16758 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016759 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16760 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16761 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016762
16763 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16764 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16765 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016766 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16767 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16768 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16769 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016770
16771 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16772 and processed the connection.
16773
16774 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16775 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16776 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16777 applications.
16778
16779 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16780 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16781 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16782 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16783 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16784
16785 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16786 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16787 See "Timers" below for more details.
16788
16789 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16790 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16791 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16792 "Timers" below for more details.
16793
16794 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016795 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016796 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16797 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16798 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16799 details.
16800
16801 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16802 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16803 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16804 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16805 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16806
16807 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16808 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16809 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16810 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16811 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16812 for more details.
16813
16814 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016815 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016816 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16817 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16818 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016819 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016820
16821 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16822 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16823 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16824 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16825 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16826 caused by a denial of service attack.
16827
16828 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16829 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16830 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16831 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16832 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16833 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16834 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16835 denial of service attack.
16836
16837 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16838 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16839 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16840 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16841 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16842 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16843 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16844 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16845 be processed than on other servers.
16846
16847 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16848 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16849 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16850 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16851 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16852 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16853 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16854 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16855 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16856 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16857 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16858 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16859 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16860
16861 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16862 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16863 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16864 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16865 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16866 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016867 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016868 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16869
16870 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16871 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16872 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16873 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16874 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16875 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016876 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016877 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16878 occurs.
16879
16880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168818.2.3. HTTP log format
16882----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016883
16884The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16885is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16886the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16887are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16888emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16889generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16890"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16891which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016892frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16893is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016894
16895Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16896slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16897with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16898
16899 Example :
16900 frontend http-in
16901 mode http
16902 option httplog
16903 log global
16904 default_backend bck
16905
16906 backend static
16907 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16908
16909 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16910 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16911 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016912 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016913
16914 Field Format Extract from the example above
16915 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16916 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016917 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016918 4 frontend_name http-in
16919 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016920 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016921 7 status_code 200
16922 8 bytes_read* 2750
16923 9 captured_request_cookie -
16924 10 captured_response_cookie -
16925 11 termination_state ----
16926 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16927 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16928 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16929 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16930 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016931
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016932Detailed fields description :
16933 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016934 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16935 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16936 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016937 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016938 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016939 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016940
16941 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016942 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16943 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16944 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016945
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016946 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16947 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016948
16949 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16950 and processed the connection.
16951
16952 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16953 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16954 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16955
16956 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16957 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16958 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16959 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16960 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16961 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016963 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16964 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16965 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16966 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16967 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16968 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016969 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16970 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971
16972 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16973 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016974 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975
16976 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16977 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016978 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16979 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016980
16981 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16982 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16983 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16984 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16985 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016986 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16987 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016988
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016989 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16990 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16991 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16992 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16993 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16994 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16995 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016996 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016997
16998 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16999 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17000 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17001
17002 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17003 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
17004 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
17005 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17006 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17007 overflowing.
17008
17009 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17010 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17011 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17012 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17013 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17014 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17015 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17016 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17017
17018 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17019 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17020 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17021 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17022 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17023 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17024 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17025 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17026
17027 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17028 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17029 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17030 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17031 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17032 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17033 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17034
17035 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017036 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17038 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17039 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017040 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017041 system.
17042
17043 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17044 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17045 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17046 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17047 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17048 caused by a denial of service attack.
17049
17050 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17051 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17052 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17053 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17054 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17055 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17056 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17057 denial of service attack.
17058
17059 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17060 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17061 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17062 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17063 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17064 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17065 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17066 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17067 processed than on other servers.
17068
17069 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17070 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17071 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17072 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17073 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17074 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17075 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17076 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17077 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17078 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17079 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17080 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17081 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17082
17083 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17084 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17085 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17086 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17087 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17088 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017089 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17091
17092 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17093 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17094 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17095 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17096 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17097 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017098 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017099 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17100 occurs.
17101
17102 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17103 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17104 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17105 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17106 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17107 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17108 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17109 cookies" below for more details.
17110
17111 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17112 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17113 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17114 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17115 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17116 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17117 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17118 and cookies" below for more details.
17119
17120 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17121 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17122 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17123 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17124 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17125 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17126 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17127 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17128
17129
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171308.2.4. Custom log format
17131------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017132
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017133The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017134mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017136HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017137Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17138separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17139prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17140
17141Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17142variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017143("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017144
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017145If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017146as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017147less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17148the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17149
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017150Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017151In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017152in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017153
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017154Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17155'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17156https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17157such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17158
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017159Flags are :
17160 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017161 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017162 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17163 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017164
17165 Example:
17166
17167 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17168 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17169
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017170 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17171
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017172At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17173
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017174 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17175 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017176
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017177the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017178
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017179 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17180 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17181 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017182
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017183and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17184
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017185 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17186 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017187
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017188Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17189
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017190 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017191 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017192 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17193 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17194 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017195 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17196 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17197 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017198 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017199 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17200 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017201 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017202 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17203 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017204 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017205 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017206 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017207 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017208 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017209 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017210 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017211 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17212 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17213 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17214 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17215 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017216 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017217 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17218 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017219 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017220 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17221 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017222 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17223 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17224 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017225 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017226 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17227 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017228 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017229 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17230 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17231 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017232 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017233 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017234 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17235 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17236 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17237 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017238 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017239 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017240 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017241 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017242 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017243 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017244 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17245 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17246 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017247 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017248 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17249 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017250 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017251 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17252 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017253 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017254 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017255 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017256 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017257
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017258 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017259
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017260
172618.2.5. Error log format
17262-----------------------
17263
17264When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17265protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17266By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17267"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017268will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017269logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17270
17271The format looks like this :
17272
17273 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17274 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17275 Connection error during SSL handshake
17276
17277 Field Format Extract from the example above
17278 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17279 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17280 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17281 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17282 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17283
17284These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17285failures.
17286
17287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172888.3. Advanced logging options
17289-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017290
17291Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17292just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17293options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17294for more information about their usage.
17295
17296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172978.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17298------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017299
17300It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17301haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17302commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17303monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17304ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17305
17306 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17307 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17308 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17309 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17310
17311 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17312 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17313 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017314 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017315 such as other load-balancers.
17316
17317 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17318 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17319 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17320
17321
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173228.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17323----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017324
17325The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17326what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17327or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017328"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017329just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17330log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17331after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17332is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17333with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17334with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17335
17336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173378.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17338------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017339
17340Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17341for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17342"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17343retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17344raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17345a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17346file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17347you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17348"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17349
17350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173518.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17352--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017353
17354Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17355multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17356them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17357"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17358logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17359error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17360and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17361too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17362useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17363alternative.
17364
17365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173668.4. Timing events
17367------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017368
17369Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17370reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17371the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17372frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017373mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17374addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17375
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017376Timings events in HTTP mode:
17377
17378 first request 2nd request
17379 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17380 t tr t tr ...
17381 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17382 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17383 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17384 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17385 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17386
17387Timings events in TCP mode:
17388
17389 TCP session
17390 |<----------------->|
17391 t t
17392 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17393 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17394 |<------ Tt ------->|
17395
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017396 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017397 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017398 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17399 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17400 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017401 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017402 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17403 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17404 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17405 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017406
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017407 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17408 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17409 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017410 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17411 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17412 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17413 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17414 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17415 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017416
17417 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17418 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17419 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17420 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17421 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17422 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17423 request typed by hand during a test.
17424
17425 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17426 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017427 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017428 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17429 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17430 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17431 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017432
17433 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17434 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17435 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17436 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17437 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17438
17439 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17440 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17441 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17442 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17443 connection never established.
17444
17445 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17446 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17447 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17448 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17449 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17450 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17451 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17452 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17453 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17454 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17455 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17456
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017457 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17458 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17459 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17460 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17461 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17462 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17463
17464 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17465
17466 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17467 "Ta" can never be negative.
17468
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017469 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17470 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017471 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17472 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017473 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017474
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017475 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017476
17477 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017478 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17479 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017480
17481These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17482protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17483that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017484due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17485"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17486that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017487
17488Most common cases :
17489
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017490 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17491 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17492 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17493 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17494 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17495 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17496 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17497 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17498 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17499 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17500 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017501 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017502
17503 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17504 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17505 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17506 of ms on remote networks.
17507
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017508 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17509 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17510 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017511
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017512 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17513 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17514 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17515 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17516 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17517 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17518 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17519 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17520 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017521
17522Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17523
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017524 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017525 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017526 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017527
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017528 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017529 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17530 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017532 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017533 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17534 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17535 flags.
17536
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017537 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17538 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017539 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17540 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17541 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17542 the client connection was maintained open.
17543
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017544 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017545 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017546 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017547 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17548
17549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175508.5. Session state at disconnection
17551-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017552
17553TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17554"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175552-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17556each of which has a special meaning :
17557
17558 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17559 session to terminate :
17560
17561 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17562
17563 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17564 server explicitly refused it.
17565
17566 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17567 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17568 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17569 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017570 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017571
17572 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17573 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017574
17575 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17576 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17577 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17578 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17579 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17580
17581 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17582 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17583 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17584 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17585 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17586
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017587 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17588 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17589
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017590 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17591 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17592 backup connections when going up.
17593
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017594 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17595
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017596 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17597 send or receive data.
17598
17599 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17600 send or receive data.
17601
17602 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17603 with nothing left in the buffers.
17604
17605 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17606
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017607 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017608 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17609
17610 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17611 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17612 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17613 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17614 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17615
17616 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17617 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17618
17619 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17620 server (HTTP only).
17621
17622 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17623
17624 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17625 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17626 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17627
17628 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17629 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17630 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17631
17632 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17633
17634 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17635 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17636
17637 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17638 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17639 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17640
17641 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17642 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017643 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17644 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017645
17646 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17647 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17648 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17649 another server.
17650
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017651 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017652 server.
17653
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017654 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17655 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17656 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17657 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17658
17659 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17660 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17661 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17662 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17663
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017664 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17665 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17666 "use-server" rule).
17667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017668 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17669
17670 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17671 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17672
17673 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17674
17675 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17676 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17677 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17678
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017679 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17680 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017681 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017682 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17683 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17684
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017685 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17686
17687 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17688 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17689
17690 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17691
17692 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17693
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017694The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17695was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017696helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17697starvation, attacks, etc...
17698
17699The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17700alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17701easier finding and understanding.
17702
17703 Flags Reason
17704
17705 -- Normal termination.
17706
17707 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17708 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17709 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17710 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17711
17712 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17713 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17714 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17715 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17716 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17717 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017718
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017719 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17720 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017721 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017722
17723 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17724 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17725 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17726
17727 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17728 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17729 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17730 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17731 the server takes too long to respond.
17732
17733 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17734 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17735 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17736 long a time to respond.
17737
17738 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17739 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17740 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17741 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017742 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17743 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744
17745 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17746 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17747 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17748 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17749 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017750 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017751 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17752 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17753 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17754 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17755 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17756 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17757 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17758 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017759 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017760 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17761 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17762 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017763
17764 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17765 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017766 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17767 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17768 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17769 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017770
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017771 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17772 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017774 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017775 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17776 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017777 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017778 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17779 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17780
17781 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17782 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17783 503 or 504 here.
17784
17785 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17786 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17787 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17788 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17789 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17790
17791 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17792 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017793 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017794 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17795 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17796
17797 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17798 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17799 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17800 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17801 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17802 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17803 between haproxy and the server.
17804
17805 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17806 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17807 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17808 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17809 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17810 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17811 solution is to fix the application.
17812
17813 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17814 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17815 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17816 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17817 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17818 external attacks.
17819
17820 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17821 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017822 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017823 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17824 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17825
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017826 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17827 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17828 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017829 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017830 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017831
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017832 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17833 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17834 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17835 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017836 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17837 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17838 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17839 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17840 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841
17842 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17843 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17844 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17845 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17846
17847 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17848 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17849 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17850 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17851
17852 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17853 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17854 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17855 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17856
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017857The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17858persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17859important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17860re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17861
17862 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17863
17864 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17865 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17866 set on a GET request.
17867
17868 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17869 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017870 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017871 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17872
17873 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17874 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17875 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17876
17877 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17878 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17879 already got a cookie.
17880
17881 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17882 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17883 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17884 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17885 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17886
17887 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17888 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17889 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17890
17891 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17892 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17893 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17894
17895 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17896 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17897
17898 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17899 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17900 then advertised in the response.
17901
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179038.6. Non-printable characters
17904-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017905
17906In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17907consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17908converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17909prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17910being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17911escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17912is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17913'}' when logging headers.
17914
17915Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17916issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17917containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17918
17919Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17920the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17921performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17922
17923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179248.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17925---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926
17927Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17928achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017929section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017930cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17931the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17932the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017933locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017934not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17935user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17936a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17937wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17938
17939 Examples :
17940 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17941 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17942
17943 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17944 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17945
17946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179478.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17948---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949
17950Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17951proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17952the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17953server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17954
17955Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17956response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017957section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017958
17959It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017960time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17961appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017962are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17963and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17964follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17965request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17966in the logs.
17967
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017968As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17969frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17970an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017972 Example :
17973 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17974 listen proxy-out
17975 mode http
17976 option httplog
17977 option logasap
17978 log global
17979 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17980
17981 # log the name of the virtual server
17982 capture request header Host len 20
17983
17984 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17985 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17986
17987 # log the beginning of the referrer
17988 capture request header Referer len 20
17989
17990 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17991 capture response header Server len 20
17992
17993 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17994 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17995
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017996 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017997 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17998
17999 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18000 capture response header Via len 20
18001
18002 # log the URL location during a redirection
18003 capture response header Location len 20
18004
18005 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18006 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18007 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18008 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18009 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18010
18011 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18012 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18013 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18014 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018015 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018016
18017 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18018 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18019 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18020 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18021 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018022 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018023
18024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180258.9. Examples of logs
18026---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018027
18028These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18029them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18030reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18031
18032 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18033 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18034 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18035
18036 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18037 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18038
18039 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18040 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18041 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18042
18043 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18044 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18045
18046 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18047 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18048 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18049
18050 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018051 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018052 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18053 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18054
18055 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18056 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18057 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18058
18059 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18060 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018061 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018062 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18063 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18064 to return the 502 and not the server.
18065
18066 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018067 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018068
18069 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18070 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18071 Nothing was sent to any server.
18072
18073 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18074 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18075
18076 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18077 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018078 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018079 send a 408 return code to the client.
18080
18081 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18082 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18083
18084 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18085 5 seconds ("c----").
18086
18087 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18088 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018089 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018090
18091 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018092 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018093 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18094 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18095 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18096 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18097 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018098
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018099
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181009. Supported filters
18101--------------------
18102
18103Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18104accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18105unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18106
18107See also : "filter"
18108
181099.1. Trace
18110----------
18111
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018112filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018113
18114 Arguments:
18115 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18116 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18117
18118 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18119 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18120 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18121 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018123 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018124 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18125 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18126 amount of the parsed data.
18127
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018128 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018129
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018130This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18131callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18132information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18133filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18134
18135Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18136tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18137a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18138
18139
181409.2. HTTP compression
18141---------------------
18142
18143filter compression
18144
18145The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18146keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018147when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18148it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18149response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18150line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18151cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18152the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018153
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018154See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018155
18156
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181579.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18158--------------------------------------------
18159
18160filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18161
18162 Arguments :
18163
18164 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18165 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18166 parsed.
18167
18168 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18169 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18170 part must be placed in its own scope.
18171
18172The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18173external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018174streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018175exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18176also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18177
18178SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18179the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18180
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018181For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018182"doc/SPOE.txt".
18183
18184Important note:
18185 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18186 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18187
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100181889.4. Cache
18189----------
18190
18191filter cache <name>
18192
18193 Arguments :
18194
18195 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18196
18197The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18198"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18199cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018200other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18201the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18202mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18203filter other than the compression is used for the same
18204listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18205order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018206
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018207See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018208
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001820910. Cache
18210---------
18211
18212HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18213(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18214RAM.
18215
18216The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018217this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018218
18219If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18220independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18221when we try to allocate a new one.
18222
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018223The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018224
18225It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18226"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18227for more details.
18228
18229When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18230replaced by "<CACHE>".
18231
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001823210.1. Limitation
18233----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018234
18235The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18236
18237- If the response is not a 200
18238- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018239- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018240- If the response is not cacheable
18241
18242- If the request is not a GET
18243- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018244- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018245
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018246Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18247filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18248can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18249example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18250"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018251
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001825210.2. Setup
18253-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018254
18255To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18256the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18257
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001825810.2.1. Cache section
18259---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018260
18261cache <name>
18262 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18263 size of cache is mandatory.
18264
18265total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018266 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018267 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018268
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018269max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018270 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18271 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18272 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018273
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018274max-age <seconds>
18275 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18276 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18277 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18278 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18279 default.
18280
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001828110.2.2. Proxy section
18282---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018283
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018284http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018285 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18286 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18287 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18288 after this one.
18289
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018290http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018291 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18292 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18293 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18294 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18295
18296
18297Example:
18298
18299 backend bck1
18300 mode http
18301
18302 http-request cache-use foobar
18303 http-response cache-store foobar
18304 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18305
18306 cache foobar
18307 total-max-size 4
18308 max-age 240
18309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018310/*
18311 * Local variables:
18312 * fill-column: 79
18313 * End:
18314 */